blob: 8a23c0ae31a1ea29370b81d505dc559f1668ed20 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6c1b6672019-02-26 16:43:49 +01007 2019/02/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100599 - wurfl-data-file
600 - wurfl-information-list
601 - wurfl-information-list-separator
602 - wurfl-engine-mode
603 - wurfl-cache-size
604 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100903 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100905 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
906 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
907 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
908
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100909 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
910 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
911 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
912 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913
914 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200915 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
916 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
917 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
918 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
919 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
920 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200921
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200922 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100924log-send-hostname [<string>]
925 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
926 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
927 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
928 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
929 the logs.
930
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931log-tag <string>
932 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
933 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
934 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100935 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000936
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100937lua-load <file>
938 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
939 used multiple times.
940
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100941master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200942 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
943 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
944 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100945 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200946 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
947 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100948 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
949 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
950 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
951 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
952 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956nbproc <number>
957 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
958 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
959 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
960 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100961 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
962 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200963
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200964nbthread <number>
965 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
966 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
967 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100968 process. See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200969
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
973 starting the process. See also "daemon".
974
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100975presetenv <name> <value>
976 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
977 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
978 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
979 and "unsetenv".
980
981resetenv [<name> ...]
982 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
983 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
984 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
985 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
986 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
987 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
988 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
989 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
990
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100991stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200992 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
993 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
994 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
995 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
996 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
997 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100998 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100999 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1000 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1001 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1002 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001003
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001004server-state-base <directory>
1005 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001006 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1007 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001008
1009server-state-file <file>
1010 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1011 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1012 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1013 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1014 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1015 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1016 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1017 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001018 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1019 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001020
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001021setenv <name> <value>
1022 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1023 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1024 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1025 and "unsetenv".
1026
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001027ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1029 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001030 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001031 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001032 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1033 information and recommendations see e.g.
1034 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1035 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1036 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1037 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001038
1039ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1040 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1041 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1042 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1043 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1044 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001045 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1046 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1047 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001048 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001049
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001050ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1052 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1053 keyword to see available options.
1054
1055 Example:
1056 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001057 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001058
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001059ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1061 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001062 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001063 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001064 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1065 information and recommendations see e.g.
1066 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1067 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1068 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1069 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1070 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001071
1072ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1073 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1074 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1075 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1076 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1077 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001078 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1079 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1080 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1081 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001082
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001083ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1085 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1086 keyword to see available options.
1087
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001088ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1089 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1090 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1091 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001092 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001093 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001094 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1095 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1096 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1097 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001098 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1099 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1100 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1101
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001102ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1103 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1104 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1105 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1106
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001107stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1108 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1109 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1110 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001111 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001112 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001113
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001114 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1115 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1116 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001117
1118stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1119 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1120 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001121 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001122
1123stats maxconn <connections>
1124 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1125 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1126
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001127uid <number>
1128 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1129 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1130 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1131 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1132
1133ulimit-n <number>
1134 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1135 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1136 option.
1137
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001138unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1139 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1140
1141 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1142 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1143 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1144 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1145 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1146 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1147 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1148 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1149 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1150 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1151
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001152unsetenv [<name> ...]
1153 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1154 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1155 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1156 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1157 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1158 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1159 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1160
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001161user <user name>
1162 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1163 See also "uid" and "group".
1164
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001165node <name>
1166 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1167
1168 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1169 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1170 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1171 traffic.
1172
1173description <text>
1174 Add a text that describes the instance.
1175
1176 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1177 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1178 "<" and ">" characters.
1179
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100118051degrees-data-file <file path>
1181 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001182 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001183
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001184 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001185 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1186
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000118751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001188 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1189 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1190 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1191
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001192 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001193 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1194
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200119551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001196 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1197 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1198
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001199 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1200 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1201
120251degrees-cache-size <number>
1203 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1204 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1205 By default, this cache is disabled.
1206
1207 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001208 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1209
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001210wurfl-data-file <file path>
1211 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1212 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1213
1214 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1215 with USE_WURFL=1.
1216
1217wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1218 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1219 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1220 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1221
1222 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1223
1224 Valid WURFL properties are:
1225 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1226
1227 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1228 device.
1229
1230 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1231 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1232
1233 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1234 particular web request.
1235
1236 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1237 used Libwurfl API version.
1238
1239 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1240 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1241 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1242
1243 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1244 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1245
1246 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1247 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1248
1249 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1250
1251 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1252
1253 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1254 with USE_WURFL=1.
1255
1256wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1257 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1258 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1259
1260 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1261 with USE_WURFL=1.
1262
1263wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1264 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1265 thus before the chroot.
1266
1267 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1268 with USE_WURFL=1.
1269
1270wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1271 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1272 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001273 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001274 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001275 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001276 mode is enabled by default.
1277
1278 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1279 with USE_WURFL=1.
1280
1281wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1282 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1283 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1284 - "0" : no cache is used.
1285 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1286 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1287 the highest performing option.
1288
1289 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1290 with USE_WURFL=1.
1291
1292wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1293 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1294 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1295
1296 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1297 with USE_WURFL=1.
1298
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013003.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001301-----------------------
1302
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001303busy-polling
1304 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1305 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1306 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1307 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1308 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1309 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1310 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1311 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1312 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1313 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1314 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1315 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1316 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1317 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1318 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1319 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1320 "poll" pollers.
1321
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001322max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1323 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1324 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1325 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1326 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1327 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1328 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1329 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1330 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1331
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001332maxconn <number>
1333 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1334 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1335 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001336 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1337 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1338 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1339 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001340 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1341 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1342 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1343 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1344 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001345
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001346maxconnrate <number>
1347 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1348 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1349 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1350 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1351 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1352 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1353 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1354 fairness.
1355
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001356maxcomprate <number>
1357 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001358 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001359 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1360 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1361 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001362 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001363 default value.
1364
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001365maxcompcpuusage <number>
1366 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1367 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1368 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1369 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1370 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1371 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1372 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1373 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1374
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001375maxpipes <number>
1376 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1377 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1378 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1379 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1380 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1381 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1382
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001383maxsessrate <number>
1384 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1385 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1386 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1387 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1388 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1389 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1390 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1391 fairness.
1392
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001393maxsslconn <number>
1394 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1395 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1396 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1397 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1398 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1399 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1400 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001401 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1402 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1403 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1404 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1405 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1406 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1407 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001408
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001409maxsslrate <number>
1410 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1411 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1412 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1413 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1414 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1415 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1416 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1417 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1418 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1419 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1420
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001421maxzlibmem <number>
1422 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1423 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1424 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001425 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1426 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1427 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1428
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001429noepoll
1430 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1431 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001432 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001433
1434nokqueue
1435 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1436 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1437 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1438
1439nopoll
1440 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1441 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001442 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001443 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001444
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001445nosplice
1446 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001447 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001448 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001449 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001450 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1451 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1452 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1453 "option splice-response".
1454
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001455nogetaddrinfo
1456 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1457 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1458
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001459noreuseport
1460 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1461 command line argument "-dR".
1462
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001463profiling.tasks { on | off }
1464 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1465 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1466 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1467 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1468 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1469 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1470 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1471 CLI.
1472
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001473spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001474 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1475 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1476 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1477 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1478 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1479 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001480
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001481ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001482 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001483 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001484 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1485 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1486 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1487 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1488 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001489 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1490 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001491 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1492 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1493 openssl configuration file uses:
1494 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1495
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001496ssl-mode-async
1497 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001498 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001499 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1500 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1501 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1502 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1503 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001504
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001505tune.buffers.limit <number>
1506 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1507 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1508 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1509 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1510 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001511 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001512 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1513 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1514 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1515 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1516 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1517 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1518 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1519 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1520 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1521
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001522tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1523 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1524 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1525 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1526 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1527
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001528tune.bufsize <number>
1529 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1530 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1531 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1532 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1533 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1534 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1535 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001536 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1537 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1538 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001539 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001540 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1541 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1542 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001543
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001544tune.chksize <number>
1545 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1546 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1547 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1548 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1549 checks whenever possible.
1550
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001551tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1552 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1553 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1554 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1555 this value. The default value is 1.
1556
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001557tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1558 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1559 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1560 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1561 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1562 change it.
1563
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001564tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1565 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001566 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1567 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001568 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1569 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1570 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1571 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1572 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1573
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001574tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1575 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1576 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1577 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1578 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1579 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1580 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1581 recommended not to change this value.
1582
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001583tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1584 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1585 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1586 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1587 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1588 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1589 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1590 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1591
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001592tune.http.cookielen <number>
1593 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1594 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1595 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1596 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1597 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1598 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1599 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1600 to change this value.
1601
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001602tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001603 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1604 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001605 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001606 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001607 configuration directives too.
1608 The default value is 1024.
1609
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001610tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1611 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1612 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1613 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1614 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1615 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1616 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001617 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1618 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1619 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001620
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001621tune.idletimer <timeout>
1622 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1623 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1624 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1625 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1626 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1627 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001628 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001629 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1630 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1631
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001632tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1633 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001634 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001635 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1636 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001637 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001638 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1639 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1640
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001641tune.lua.maxmem
1642 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1643 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1644 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1645 memory.
1646
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001647tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1648 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001649 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1650 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001651 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001652
1653tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1654 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1655 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1656 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1657 check servers.
1658
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001659tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1660 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1661 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1662 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001663 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001664
Olivier Houcharddc21ff72019-01-29 15:20:16 +01001665tune.fail-alloc
1666 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1667 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1668 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1669 gracefully.
1670
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001671tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001672 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1673 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1674 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1675 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1676 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1677 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1678 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1679 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1680 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1681 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001682
1683tune.maxpollevents <number>
1684 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1685 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1686 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1687 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1688 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1689
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001690tune.maxrewrite <number>
1691 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1692 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1693 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1694 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1695 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1696 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1697 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1698 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1699 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1700 bufsize.
1701
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001702tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1703 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1704 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1705 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1706 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1707 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1708 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1709 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1710 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1711 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1712 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1713 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1714 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1715 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1716 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1717 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1718 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1719 setting this parameter to 0.
1720
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001721tune.pipesize <number>
1722 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1723 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1724 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1725 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1726 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1727 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1728
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001729tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1730tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1731 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1732 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1733 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1734 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001735 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001736 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1737 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1738
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001739tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001741 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1742 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1743 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1744 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1745
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001746tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1747 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1748 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1749 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1750
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001751tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1752tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1753 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1754 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1755 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1756 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001757 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001758 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1759 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1760 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1761 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1762 notifying haproxy again.
1763
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001764tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001765 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1766 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1767 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001768 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001769 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001770 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001771 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1772 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1773 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001774 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1775 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001776
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001777tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001778 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001779 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1780 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1781 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1782 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1783 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1784
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001785tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1786 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001787 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001788 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1789 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1790 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1791 being used for too long.
1792
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001793tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1794 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1795 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1796 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1797 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1798 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1799 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1800 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1801 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1802 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1803 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001804 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001805 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001806
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001807tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1808 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1809 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1810 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1811 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1812 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1813 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1814 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001815 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1816 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001817
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001818tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1819 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1820 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1821 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1822 1000 entries.
1823
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001824tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1825 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1826 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1827 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1828
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001829tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001830tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001831tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1832tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1833tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001834 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1835 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1836 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1837 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1838 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1839 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1840 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1841 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001842
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001843 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1844 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1845 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1846 all available space is consumed.
1847 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1848 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1849 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001850
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001851tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1852 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001853 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001854 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001855 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001856 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1857
1858tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1859 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1860 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001861 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1862 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018643.3. Debugging
1865--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001866
1867debug
1868 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1869 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1870 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1871 system startup.
1872
1873quiet
1874 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1875 line argument "-q".
1876
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001877
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018783.4. Userlists
1879--------------
1880It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1881http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1882it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1883
1884userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001885 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001886 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1887
1888group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001889 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001890 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1891 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1892
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001893user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1894 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001895 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1896 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001897 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1898 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1899 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1900 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001901
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001902 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1903 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1904 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1905 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1906 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1907 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1908 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1909 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1910 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001911
1912 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001913 userlist L1
1914 group G1 users tiger,scott
1915 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001916
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001917 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1918 user scott insecure-password elgato
1919 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001920
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001921 userlist L2
1922 group G1
1923 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001924
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001925 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1926 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1927 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001928
1929 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001930
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001931
19323.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001933----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001934It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1935several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1936instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1937values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1938automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1939In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1940using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1941tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1942reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1943Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1944that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1945each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001946
1947peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001948 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001949 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1950
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001951bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1952 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
1953 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
1954
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001955disabled
1956 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1957 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1958 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1959
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001960default-bind [param*]
1961 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
1962
1963default-server [param*]
1964 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
1965
1966 Arguments:
1967 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1968 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1969 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1970 details.
1971
1972
1973 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
1974
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001975enable
1976 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1977
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001978peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001979 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1980 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1981 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1982 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1983 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1984 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1985
1986 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1987 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1988
1989 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1990 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1991 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1992 across all peers.
1993
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001994 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1995 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001996
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001997 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
1998 "server" keyword explanation below).
1999
2000server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
2001 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
2002 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2003 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2004 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2005 of this "peers" section).
2006 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2007
2008
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002009 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002010 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002011 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002012 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2013 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2014 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002015
2016 backend mybackend
2017 mode tcp
2018 balance roundrobin
2019 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2020 stick on src
2021
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002022 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2023 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002024
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002025 Example:
2026 peers mypeers
2027 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2028 default-server ssl verify none
2029 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2030 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002031
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090020323.6. Mailers
2033------------
2034It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2035If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2036in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2037
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002038mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002039 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2040 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2041
2042mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2043 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2044
2045 Example:
2046 mailers mymailers
2047 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2048 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2049
2050 backend mybackend
2051 mode tcp
2052 balance roundrobin
2053
2054 email-alert mailers mymailers
2055 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2056 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2057
2058 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2059 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2060
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002061timeout mail <time>
2062 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2063 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2064 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2065 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2066
2067 Example:
2068 mailers mymailers
2069 timeout mail 20s
2070 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020724. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002073----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002075Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002076 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002077 - frontend <name>
2078 - backend <name>
2079 - listen <name>
2080
2081A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2082its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2083section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002085
2086A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2087connections.
2088
2089A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2090to forward incoming connections.
2091
2092A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2093parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002095All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2096'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2097case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2098
2099Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2100logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2101proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2102However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2103name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2104
2105Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2106and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002107bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002108protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2109modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2110arbitrary criteria.
2111
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002112In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2113a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002114the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002115
2116 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2117 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2118 between responses and new requests.
2119
2120 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2121 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2122 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002123 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2124 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002125
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002126 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2127 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2128 client-facing connection remains open.
2129
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002130 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2131 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002132
2133The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2134frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2135following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002136weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002137
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002138 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002139
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002140 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2141 ----+-----+-----+----
2142 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2143 ----+-----+-----+----
2144 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2145 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2146 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2147 ----+-----+-----+----
2148 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002149
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002150
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2153--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002155The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2156limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2157they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2158limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002159marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002160option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002161and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2162with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2163specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002164
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002165
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002166 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2167------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2168acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002169appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002170backlog X X X -
2171balance X - X X
2172bind - X X -
2173bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002174block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002175capture cookie - X X -
2176capture request header - X X -
2177capture response header - X X -
2178clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002179compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002180contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2181cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002182declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002183default-server X - X X
2184default_backend X X X -
2185description - X X X
2186disabled X X X X
2187dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002188email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002189email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002190email-alert mailers X X X X
2191email-alert myhostname X X X X
2192email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002193enabled X X X X
2194errorfile X X X X
2195errorloc X X X X
2196errorloc302 X X X X
2197-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2198errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002199force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002200filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002201fullconn X - X X
2202grace X X X X
2203hash-type X - X X
2204http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002205http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002206http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002207http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002208http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002209http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002210http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002211id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002212ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002213load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002214log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002215log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002216log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002217log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002218max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002219maxconn X X X -
2220mode X X X X
2221monitor fail - X X -
2222monitor-net X X X -
2223monitor-uri X X X -
2224option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2225option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2226option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2227option allbackups (*) X - X X
2228option checkcache (*) X - X X
2229option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2230option contstats (*) X X X -
2231option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2232option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002233option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002234-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2235option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002236option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002237option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002238option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002239option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002240option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002241option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002242option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002243option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002244option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002245option httpchk X - X X
2246option httpclose (*) X X X X
2247option httplog X X X X
2248option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002249option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002250option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002251option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002252option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2253option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2254option logasap (*) X X X -
2255option mysql-check X - X X
2256option nolinger (*) X X X X
2257option originalto X X X X
2258option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002259option pgsql-check X - X X
2260option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002261option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002262option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002263option smtpchk X - X X
2264option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2265option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2266option splice-request (*) X X X X
2267option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002268option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002269option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2270option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2271-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002272option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002273option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2274option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2275option tcpka X X X X
2276option tcplog X X X X
2277option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002278external-check command X - X X
2279external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002280persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2281rate-limit sessions X X X -
2282redirect - X X X
2283redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2284redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2285reqadd - X X X
2286reqallow - X X X
2287reqdel - X X X
2288reqdeny - X X X
2289reqiallow - X X X
2290reqidel - X X X
2291reqideny - X X X
2292reqipass - X X X
2293reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002294reqitarpit - X X X
2295reqpass - X X X
2296reqrep - X X X
2297-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002298reqtarpit - X X X
2299retries X - X X
2300rspadd - X X X
2301rspdel - X X X
2302rspdeny - X X X
2303rspidel - X X X
2304rspideny - X X X
2305rspirep - X X X
2306rsprep - X X X
2307server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002308server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002309server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002310source X - X X
2311srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002312stats admin - X X X
2313stats auth X X X X
2314stats enable X X X X
2315stats hide-version X X X X
2316stats http-request - X X X
2317stats realm X X X X
2318stats refresh X X X X
2319stats scope X X X X
2320stats show-desc X X X X
2321stats show-legends X X X X
2322stats show-node X X X X
2323stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002324-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2325stick match - - X X
2326stick on - - X X
2327stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002328stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002329stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002330tcp-check connect - - X X
2331tcp-check expect - - X X
2332tcp-check send - - X X
2333tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002334tcp-request connection - X X -
2335tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002336tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002337tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002338tcp-response content - - X X
2339tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002340timeout check X - X X
2341timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002342timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002343timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2344timeout connect X - X X
2345timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2346timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2347timeout http-request X X X X
2348timeout queue X - X X
2349timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002350timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002351timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2352timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002353timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002354transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002355unique-id-format X X X -
2356unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002357use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002358use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002359------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2360 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002361
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023634.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2364---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365
2366This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2367
2368
2369acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2370 Declare or complete an access list.
2371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2372 no | yes | yes | yes
2373 Example:
2374 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2375 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2376 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002378 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379
2380
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002381appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2382 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2385 no | no | yes | yes
2386 Arguments :
2387 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2388 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2389
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002390 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002391 checked in each cookie value.
2392
2393 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2394 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2395 milliseconds.
2396
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002397 request-learn
2398 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2399 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2400 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2401 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2402 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2403 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2404
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002405 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2406 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2407 data following this prefix.
2408
2409 Example :
2410 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2411
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002412 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2413 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002414
2415 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2416 2 modes are currently supported :
2417 - path-parameters :
2418 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2419 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2420 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2421 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2422 - query-string :
2423 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2424 query string.
2425
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002426 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2427 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2428 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002429
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002430 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2431 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002432
2433
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002434backlog <conns>
2435 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2437 yes | yes | yes | no
2438 Arguments :
2439 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2440 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002441 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002442
2443 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2444 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2445 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2446 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2447 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2448 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2449 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2450 backlog parameter.
2451
2452 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2453 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2454 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2455
2456 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2457
2458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002459balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002460balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2463 yes | no | yes | yes
2464 Arguments :
2465 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2466 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2467 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2468 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2469
2470 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2471 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2472 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2473 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002474 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002475 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002476 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2477 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2478 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2479 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2480 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2481 it, so that you don't worry.
2482
2483 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2484 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2485 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2486 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2487 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2488 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2489 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2490 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002492 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2493 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2494 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2495 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2496 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2497 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2498 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2499 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2500
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002501 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002502 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002503 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2504 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002505 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002506 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2507 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2508 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2509 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2510 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002511 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2512 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2513 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2514 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2515 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2516 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002518 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2519 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2520 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2521 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2522 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2523 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2524 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2525 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002526 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002527 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002528 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2529 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2530 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002531
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002532 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2533 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2534 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2535 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2536 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2537 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2538 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2539 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2540 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2541 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2542 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2543 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002544
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002545 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002546 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2547 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2548 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2549 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2550 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2551 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2552 URIs start with a leading "/".
2553
2554 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2555 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2556 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2557 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2558
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002559 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002560 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2561
2562 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002563 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2564 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002565 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2566 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2567 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2568 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002569 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002570 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2571 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002572
2573 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2574 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2575 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2576 server will receive the request.
2577
2578 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2579 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2580 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2581 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2582 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002583 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2584 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2585 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002587 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2588 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2589 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2590 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2591 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002593 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002594 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2595 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2596 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2597
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002598 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2599 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2600 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2601
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002602 random
2603 random(<draws>)
2604 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002605 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2606 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2607 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2608 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002609 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2610 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2611 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2612 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2613 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2614 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2615 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2616 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2617 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2618 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2619 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2620 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2621 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2622 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2623 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2624 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2625 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2626 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2627 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2628 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002629
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002630 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002631 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002632 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2633 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2634 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2635 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2636 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2637 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002638 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002639 used instead.
2640
2641 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2642 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2643 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2644 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2645
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002646 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2647 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2648 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2649
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002650 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002651
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002652 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002653 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2654 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002655
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002656 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2657 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2658 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002659
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002660 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2661 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2662 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2663 NTLM relies on.
2664
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002665 Examples :
2666 balance roundrobin
2667 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002668 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002669 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2670 balance hdr(host)
2671 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002672
2673 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2674 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002676 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002677 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2678 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2679 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2680 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2681
2682 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2683 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2684 defaults to 16 kB.
2685
2686 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2687 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2688
2689 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2690 Round Robin.
2691
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002692 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002693 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2694 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2695 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2696
2697 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2698
2699 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002700 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002701 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2702 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2703 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002704
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002705 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002706
2707
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002708bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2709bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002710 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2712 no | yes | yes | no
2713 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002714 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2715 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2716 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2717 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002718 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002719 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2720 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2721 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2722 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2723 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2724 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2725 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002726 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2727 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2728 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2729 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2730 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2731 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2732 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002733 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2734 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2735 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002736 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2737 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2738 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2739 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002740 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2741 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2742 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002743
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002744 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2745 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002746 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2747 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2748 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002749 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2750 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2751 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2752 the range.
2753
2754 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2755 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2756 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2757 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2758 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2759 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2760 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002761 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002762 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002764 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002765 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002766 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2767 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2768 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2769 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2770 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2771 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2772
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002773 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2774 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2775 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2776 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002778 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2779 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2780 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2781 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2782 in a frontend.
2783
2784 Example :
2785 listen http_proxy
2786 bind :80,:443
2787 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002788 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002789
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002790 listen http_https_proxy
2791 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002792 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002793
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002794 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2795 bind ipv6@:80
2796 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2797 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2798
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002799 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002800 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002801
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002802 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2803 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2804 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2805 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2806 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2807
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002808 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002809 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002810
2811
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002812bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002813 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2815 yes | yes | yes | yes
2816 Arguments :
2817 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2818 may be used to override a default value.
2819
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002820 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002821 option may be combined with other numbers.
2822
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002823 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002824 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2825 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2826 missing from all processes.
2827
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002828 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002829 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002830 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2831 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2832 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2833 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2834 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002835 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002836
2837 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2838 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2839 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2840 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2841 and 'even' instances.
2842
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002843 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2844 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2845 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2846 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002847
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002848 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2849 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2850
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002851 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2852 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2853 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2854
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002855 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2856 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2857
2858 Example :
2859 listen app_ip1
2860 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002861 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002862
2863 listen app_ip2
2864 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002865 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002866
2867 listen management
2868 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002869 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002870
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002871 listen management
2872 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2873 bind-process 1-4
2874
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002875 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002876
2877
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002878block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002879 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2881 no | yes | yes | yes
2882
2883 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2884 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002885 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002886 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002887 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002888 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2889 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2890 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002892 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2893 "http-request deny" instead.
2894
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002895 Example:
2896 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2897 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2898 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002899 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2900 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2901 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002902
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002903 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2904 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2905 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002906
2907capture cookie <name> len <length>
2908 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2910 no | yes | yes | no
2911 Arguments :
2912 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2913 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2914 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2915 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002916 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917
2918 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2919 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2920 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2921 right if it exceeds <length>.
2922
2923 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2924 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2925 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2926 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2927
2928 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2929 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2930 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2931
2932 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2933 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2934 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002935 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2936 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2937 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938
2939 Example:
2940 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2941
2942 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002943 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002944
2945
2946capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002947 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2949 no | yes | yes | no
2950 Arguments :
2951 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002952 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002953 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2954 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2955 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2956
2957 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2958 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2959 it exceeds <length>.
2960
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002961 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2963 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002964 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2965 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2966 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2967 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002968 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002969 environments to find where the request came from.
2970
2971 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2972 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2973 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2974 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002975
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002976 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2977 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2978 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2979 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2980 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002981
2982 Example:
2983 capture request header Host len 15
2984 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002985 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002987 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002988 about logging.
2989
2990
2991capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002992 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2994 no | yes | yes | no
2995 Arguments :
2996 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002997 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002998 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2999 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3000 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3001
3002 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3003 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3004 it exceeds <length>.
3005
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003006 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003007 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3008 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3009 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003010 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3011 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3012 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3013 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003014
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003015 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3016 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3017 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3018 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3019 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003020
3021 Example:
3022 capture response header Content-length len 9
3023 capture response header Location len 15
3024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003025 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003026 about logging.
3027
3028
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003029clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003030 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3032 yes | yes | yes | no
3033 Arguments :
3034 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3035 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3036 as explained at the top of this document.
3037
3038 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3039 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3040 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3041 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3042 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3043 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3044 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3045 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003046 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003047 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003048 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049
3050 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3051 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3052 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3053 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3054 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3055 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3056
3057 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3058 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3059
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003060 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3061 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003062
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003063compression algo <algorithm> ...
3064compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003065compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003066 Enable HTTP compression.
3067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3068 yes | yes | yes | yes
3069 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003070 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3071 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3072 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3073
3074 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003075 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3076 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3077 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003078
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003079 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003080 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003081
3082 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3083 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3084 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3085 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3086 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003087 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003088
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003089 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3090 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3091 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3092 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3093 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3094 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3095 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003096 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003097
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003098 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003099 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003100 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3101 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3102 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3103 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3104 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003105
3106 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3107 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3108 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3109 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3110 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003111 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3112 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3113 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3114 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3115 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003116 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3117 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003118
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003119 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003120 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3121 "Accept-Encoding" header
3122 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003123 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003124 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3125 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3126 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3127 "multipart"
3128 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3129 header
3130 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3131 and later
3132 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3133 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003134 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003135
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003136 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003137
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003138 Examples :
3139 compression algo gzip
3140 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003141
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003142
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003143contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3146 yes | no | yes | yes
3147 Arguments :
3148 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3150 as explained at the top of this document.
3151
3152 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003153 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003154 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003155 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3157 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3158 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3159
3160 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3161 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3162 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3163 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3164 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3165 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3166
3167 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3168 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3169 instead.
3170
3171 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3172 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3173
3174
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003175cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003176 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3177 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003178 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003179 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3181 yes | no | yes | yes
3182 Arguments :
3183 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3184 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3185 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3186 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3187 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3188 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003189 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003190 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3191 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3192
3193 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3194 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3195 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3196 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3197 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3198 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003199 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3200 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003201 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003202 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3203 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003204
3205 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003206 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003207
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003208 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003209 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3210 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003211 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003212 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3213 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3214 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3215 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3216 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3217 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3218 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003219
3220 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3221 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3222 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3223 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3224 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3225 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3226 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3227 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3228 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003229 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003230 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3231 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3232 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003233
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003234 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3235 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3236 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003237 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3238 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3239 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3240 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003241 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3242 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3243 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003244
3245 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3246 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3247 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3248 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3249 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3250 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3251 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3252 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3253 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3254
3255 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3256 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3257 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3258 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3259 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3260 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3261 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3262 persistence cookie in the cache.
3263 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3264
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003265 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3266 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3267 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3268 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3269 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003270 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003271 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3272 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3273 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3274 they logout.
3275
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003276 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3277 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3278 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3279 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3280
3281 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3282 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3283 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3284 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3285 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3286 this attribute.
3287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003288 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003289 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003290 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3291 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3292 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3293 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3294 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3295 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003296
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003297 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3298 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3299 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3300 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3301 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3302 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3303 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3304 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003305 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003306 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3307 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3308 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3309 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3310 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3311 the site.
3312
3313 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3314 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3315 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3316 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3317 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3318 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3319 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3320 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3321 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3322 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3323 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3324 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3325 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003326 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003327 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3328 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3329
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003330 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3331 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3332 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3333 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3334 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3335 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003337 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3338 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3339 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3340 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003342 Examples :
3343 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3344 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3345 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003346 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003347
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003348 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003349
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003350
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003351declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3352 Declares a capture slot.
3353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3354 no | yes | yes | no
3355 Arguments:
3356 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3357
3358 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3359 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3360 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3361 for use in the response.
3362
3363 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003364 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003365 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3366
3367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003368default-server [param*]
3369 Change default options for a server in a backend
3370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3371 yes | no | yes | yes
3372 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003373 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3374 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3375 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3376 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003377
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003378 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003379 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3380
3381 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003382
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003383
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384default_backend <backend>
3385 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3387 yes | yes | yes | no
3388 Arguments :
3389 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3390
3391 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3392 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3393 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3394 will catch all undetermined requests.
3395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003396 Example :
3397
3398 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3399 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3400 default_backend dynamic
3401
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003402 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003404
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003405description <string>
3406 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3408 no | yes | yes | yes
3409 Arguments : string
3410
3411 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3412 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3413 it describes.
3414 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3415
3416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003417disabled
3418 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3420 yes | yes | yes | yes
3421 Arguments : none
3422
3423 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3424 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3425 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3426 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3427 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3428 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3429 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3430
3431 See also : "enabled"
3432
3433
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003434dispatch <address>:<port>
3435 Set a default server address
3436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3437 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003438 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003439
3440 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3441 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3442 during start-up.
3443
3444 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3445 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3446 possible with normal servers.
3447
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003448 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003449 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3450 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3451 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3452 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3453
3454 See also : "server"
3455
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003456
3457dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3458 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3460 yes | no | yes | yes
3461 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3462
3463 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003464 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003465 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3466 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003467 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003468 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003470enabled
3471 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3473 yes | yes | yes | yes
3474 Arguments : none
3475
3476 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3477 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3478
3479 See also : "disabled"
3480
3481
3482errorfile <code> <file>
3483 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3485 yes | yes | yes | yes
3486 Arguments :
3487 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003488 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3489 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003490
3491 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003492 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003493 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003494 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3495 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003496
3497 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3498 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3499 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3500
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003501 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3502
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003503 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3504 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3505 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3506 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3507
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003508 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3509 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003510 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003511 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3512 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3513 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3514
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003515 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3516 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3517 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003518 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3520
3521 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3522
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003523 Example :
3524 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003525 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003526 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3527 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3528
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003529
3530errorloc <code> <url>
3531errorloc302 <code> <url>
3532 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3534 yes | yes | yes | yes
3535 Arguments :
3536 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003537 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3538 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003539
3540 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3541 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3542 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3543 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003544 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003545
3546 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3547 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3548 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3549
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003550 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3551
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003552 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3553 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3554 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3555 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003556 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003557 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3558 request.
3559
3560 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3561
3562
3563errorloc303 <code> <url>
3564 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3566 yes | yes | yes | yes
3567 Arguments :
3568 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003569 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3570 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003571
3572 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3573 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3574 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3575 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003576 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003577
3578 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3579 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3580 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3581
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003582 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3583
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003584 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3585 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3586 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3587 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003588 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003589
3590 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3591
3592
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003593email-alert from <emailaddr>
3594 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003595 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003596 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3597 yes | yes | yes | yes
3598
3599 Arguments :
3600
3601 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3602
3603 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3604 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3605
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003606 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003607 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3608 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003609
3610
3611email-alert level <level>
3612 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3613 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3614 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3615 yes | yes | yes | yes
3616
3617 Arguments :
3618
3619 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3620 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3621 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3622
3623 By default level is alert
3624
3625 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3626 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3627 for the proxy.
3628
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003629 Alerts are sent when :
3630
3631 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3632 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3633 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3634 is notice or lower
3635 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3636 and a health check status update occurs
3637
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003638 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3639 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003640 section 3.6 about mailers.
3641
3642
3643email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3644 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3645 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3646 yes | yes | yes | yes
3647
3648 Arguments :
3649
3650 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3651
3652 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3653 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3654
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003655 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3656 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003657
3658
3659email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3660 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3661 mailers.
3662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3663 yes | yes | yes | yes
3664
3665 Arguments :
3666
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003667 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003668
3669 By default the systems hostname is used.
3670
3671 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3672 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3673 for the proxy.
3674
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003675 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3676 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003677
3678
3679email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003680 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003681 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3682 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3683 yes | yes | yes | yes
3684
3685 Arguments :
3686
3687 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3688
3689 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3690 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3691
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003692 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003693 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3694
3695
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003696force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3697 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3698 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003699 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003700
3701 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3702 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3703 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3704 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3705 marked down for maintenance operations.
3706
3707 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3708 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3709 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3710 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3711 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3712 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3713 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3714 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3715 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3716
3717 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3718 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3719 is used.
3720
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003721 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003722 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003723
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003724
3725filter <name> [param*]
3726 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3728 no | yes | yes | yes
3729 Arguments :
3730 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3731 referenced in section 9.
3732
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003733 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003734 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003735 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3736 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003737
3738 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3739 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3740
3741 Example:
3742 listen
3743 bind *:80
3744
3745 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3746 filter compression
3747 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3748
3749 compression algo gzip
3750 compression offload
3751
3752 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3753
3754 See also : section 9.
3755
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003756
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003757fullconn <conns>
3758 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3760 yes | no | yes | yes
3761 Arguments :
3762 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3763 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3764
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003765 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003766 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003767 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003768 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3769 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3770 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3771 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3772 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003773 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003774
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003775 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3776 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003777 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3778 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3779 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003781 Example :
3782 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3783 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3784 # connections.
3785 backend dynamic
3786 fullconn 10000
3787 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3788 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3789
3790 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3791
3792
3793grace <time>
3794 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003796 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003797 Arguments :
3798 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3799 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3800 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3801
3802 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3803 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003804 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003805 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3806
3807 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3808 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3809 simplify it.
3810
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003811
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003812hash-balance-factor <factor>
3813 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3815 yes | no | no | yes
3816 Arguments :
3817 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3818 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3819 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3820
3821 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3822 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3823 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3824 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3825 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3826 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3827 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3828
3829 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3830 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3831 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3832 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3833 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3834
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003835 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3836 consistent hashing mechanism.
3837
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003838 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3839
3840
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003841hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003842 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 yes | no | yes | yes
3845 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003846 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3847 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003848
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003849 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3850 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3851 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3852 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3853 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3854 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3855 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3856 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3857 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3858 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003859
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003860 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3861 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3862 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3863 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3864 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3865 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3866 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3867 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3868 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3869 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3870 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3871 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3872 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003873 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3874 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003875
3876 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3877
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003878 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003879 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3880 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3881 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003882 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3883 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3884 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003885
3886 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3887 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003888 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3889 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3890 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3891 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3892
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003893 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3894 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3895 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3896 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3897 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3898 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3899 parameter.
3900
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003901 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3902 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3903 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3904 used on strings.
3905
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003906 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3907
3908 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3909 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3910 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3911 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3912 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3913 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3914 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3915 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3916 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3917 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3918 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3919 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003920
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003921 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3922 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3923 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003924
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003925 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003926
3927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003928http-check disable-on-404
3929 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003931 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003932 Arguments : none
3933
3934 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3935 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3936 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3937 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3938 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3939 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3940 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3941 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003942 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3943 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3944 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3945
3946 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3947
3948
3949http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003950 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003952 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003953 Arguments :
3954 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3955 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003956 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003957 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3958 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3959 details on the supported keywords.
3960
3961 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3962 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3963 with the usual backslash ('\').
3964
3965 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3966 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3967 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3968 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3969 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3970
3971 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003972 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003973 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3974 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3975 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3976
3977 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003978 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003979 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3980 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3981 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3982 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3983
3984 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003985 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003986 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3987 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3988 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3989 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3990 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003991 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003992 trace).
3993
3994 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003995 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003996 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3997 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3998 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3999 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4000 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004001 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004002
4003 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4004 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4005 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4006 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4007 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4008 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4009 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4010 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4011
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004012 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4013 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4014 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4015
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004016 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4017 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4018
4019 Examples :
4020 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004021 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004022
4023 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004024 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004025
4026 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004027 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004028
4029 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004030 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004031
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004032 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004033
4034
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004035http-check send-state
4036 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4038 yes | no | yes | yes
4039 Arguments : none
4040
4041 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4042 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4043 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4044 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4045 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4046
4047 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4048 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4049 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4050 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4051 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004052 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4053 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4054 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4055
4056 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4057 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4058 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4059
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004060 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4061 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4062 checked in multiple backends.
4063
4064 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4065 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4066
4067 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4068 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4069 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4070 one fails.
4071
4072 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4073 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4074 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4075
4076 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4077 server's queue.
4078
4079 Example of a header received by the application server :
4080 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4081 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4082
4083 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004085
4086http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004087 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4088
4089 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4090 no | yes | yes | yes
4091
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004092 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4093 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4094 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4095 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4096 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004097
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004098 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4099 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004101 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004103 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4104 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4105 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4106 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004108 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4109 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4110 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4111 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004113 Example:
4114 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4115 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4116 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004118 http-request allow if nagios
4119 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4120 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4121 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004123 Example:
4124 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4125 acl add path /addacl
4126 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004128 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004129
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004130 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4131 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004132
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004133 Example:
4134 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4135 acl setmap path /setmap
4136 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004138 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004139
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004140 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4141 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004143 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4144 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004146http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004148 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4149 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4150 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4151 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4152 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4153 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4154 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4155 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004157http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004159 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4160 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4161 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4162 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4163 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4164 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4165 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4166 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004168http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004170 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4171 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004172
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004174http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004176 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4177 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4178 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4179 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4180 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004182 Example:
4183 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4184 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004185
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004186http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004188 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004190http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4191 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004192
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004193 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4194 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4195 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4196 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4197 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4198 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4199 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4200 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4201 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004203 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4204 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4205 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4206 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4207 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4208 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004210http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004212 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4213 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4214 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4215 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4216 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4217 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004219http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004221 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004223http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4226 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4227 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4228 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4229 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4230 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004232http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004234 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4235 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4236 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4237 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4238 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004239
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004240http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4241
4242 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4243 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4244 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4245 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004246 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4247 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004248
4249 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004251http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004253 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4254 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4255 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4256 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4257 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004261 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4262 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4263 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4264 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004266http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4267 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004269 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4270 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4271 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4272 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4273 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4274 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4275 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4276 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278 Example:
4279 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004281 # applied to:
4282 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 # outputs:
4285 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004287 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4290 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4293 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4294 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4295 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004296
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004297 Example:
4298 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004300 # applied to:
4301 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004302
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004303 # outputs:
4304 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004306http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4307http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4310 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4311 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004313http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004315 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4316 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4317 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004318
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004319http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4322 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4323 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4324 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4325 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327 Arguments:
4328 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4329 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 Example:
4332 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4333 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4336 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4341 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4342 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004343
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004344 Arguments:
4345 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4346 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348 Example:
4349 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4350 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004352 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4353 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4354 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004358 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4359 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4360 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4361 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4362 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004364 Example:
4365 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4366 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4367 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4368 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4369 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4370 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4371 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4372 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4373 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004375http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004377 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4378 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4379 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4380 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4381 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004383http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4384 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4387 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4388 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4389 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4390 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4391 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4392 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4393 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4394 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004398 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4399 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4400 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4401 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4402 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4403 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4404 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004406http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004408 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4409 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4410 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004412http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004414 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4415 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4416 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4417 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4418 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4419 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4420 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4421 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004423http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004424
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004425 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4426 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4427 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4428 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4429 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4430 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004432 Example :
4433 # prepend the host name before the path
4434 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004436http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004438 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4439 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4440 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4441 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4442 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004446 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4447 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4448 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4449 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4450 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4451 values have higher priority.
4452 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4453 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4454 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4455 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4456 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004458http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004459
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004460 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4461 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4462 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4463 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4464 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4465 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4466 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004467
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004468 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004469
4470 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004471 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4472 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004473
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004474http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4475 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4476 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4477 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4478 privacy.
4479
4480 Arguments :
4481 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4482 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004483
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004484 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004485 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4486 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4487
4488 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4489 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4490
4491http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4492
4493 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4494 expression.
4495
4496 Arguments:
4497 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4498 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004499
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004500 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4502 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4503
4504 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4505 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4506 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4507
4508http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4509
4510 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4511 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4512 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4513 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4514 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4515 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4516 information from the request.
4517
4518 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4519
4520http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4521
4522 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4523 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4524 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4525 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4526 path and the query string.
4527 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4528
4529http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4530
4531 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4532 inline.
4533
4534 Arguments:
4535 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4536 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4537 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4538 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4539 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4540 (request and response)
4541 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4542 processing
4543 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4544 processing
4545 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4546 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4547 and '_'.
4548
4549 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4550 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004551
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004552 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004553 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004554
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004555http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4556 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004558 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4559 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4560 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4561 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4562 agent name must be used.
4563
4564 Arguments:
4565 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4566
4567 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4568 configuration.
4569
4570http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4571
4572 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4573 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4574 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4575 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4576 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4577 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4578 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4579 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4580 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4581 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4582 action.
4583 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4584 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4585 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4586 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4587 you fully understand how it works.
4588
4589http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4590
4591 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4592 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4593 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4594 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4595 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4596 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4597 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4598 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4599 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4600 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4601 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4602 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4603 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4604
4605http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4606http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4607http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4608
4609 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4610 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4611 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4612 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4613 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4614 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4615 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4616 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4617 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4618 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4619 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4620 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4621
4622 Arguments :
4623 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4624 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4625 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4626 select which table entry to update the counters.
4627
4628 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4629 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4630 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4631 that table until the session ends.
4632
4633 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4634 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4635 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4636 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4637 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4638 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4639 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4640 useful information.
4641
4642 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4643 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4644 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4645 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4646 checks that make use of it.
4647
4648http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4649
4650 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004651
4652 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004653 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004655http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004657 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4658 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4659 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004660
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004661
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004662http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004663 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4664
4665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4666 no | yes | yes | yes
4667
4668 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4669 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4670 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4671 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4672 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4673 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4674
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004675 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4676 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004677
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004678 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004679
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004680 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4681 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4682 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4683 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004684
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004685 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4686 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4687 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4688 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004689
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004690 Example:
4691 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004692
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004693 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004694
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004695 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4696 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004697
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004698 Example:
4699 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004700
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004701 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004702
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004703 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4704 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004705
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004706 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4707 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004708
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004709http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004710
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004711 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4712 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4713 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4714 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4715 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4716 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4717 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4718 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004719
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004720http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004721
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004722 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4723 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4724 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4725 example, or to pass some internal information.
4726 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4727 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4728 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004730http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004731
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004732 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4733 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004734
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004735http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004736
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004737 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004738
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004739http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004740
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004741 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4742 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4743 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4744 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4745 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4746 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4747 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004748
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004749 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4750 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4751 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4752 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4753 keyword.
4754 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4755 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004757http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004759 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4760 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4761 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4762 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4763 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4764 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004765
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004766http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004767
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004768 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004769
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004770http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004771
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004772 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4773 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4774 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4775 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4776 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4777 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004778
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004779http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004780
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004781 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4782 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004783
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004784http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004785
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004786 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4787 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4788 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4789 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4790 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4791 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004792
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004793http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4794 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004795
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004796 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4797 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4798 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4799 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4800 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4801 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4802 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4803 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004804
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004805 Example:
4806 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004807
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004808 # applied to:
4809 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004810
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004811 # outputs:
4812 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004813
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004814 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004815
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004816http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4817 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004818
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004819 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4820 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4821 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4822 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004823
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004824 Example:
4825 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004827 # applied to:
4828 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004830 # outputs:
4831 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004832
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004833http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4834http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004836 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4837 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4838 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004840http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004841
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004842 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4843 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4844 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004846http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004847
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004848 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4849 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4850 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4851 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4852 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004854 Arguments:
4855 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004857 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4858 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004859
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004860http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004861
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004862 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4863 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4864 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004865
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004866http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4867
4868 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4869 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4870 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4871 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4872 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4873
4874http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4875
4876 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4877 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4878 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4879 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4880 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4881 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4882 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4883 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4884 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4885
4886http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4887
4888 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4889 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4890 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4891 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4892 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4893 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4894 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4895
4896http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4897
4898 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4899 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4900 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4901 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4902 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4903 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4904 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4905 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4906
4907http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4908 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4909
4910 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4911 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4912 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4913 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004914
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004915 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004916 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4917 http-response set-status 431
4918 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4919 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004920
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004921http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004922
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004923 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4924 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4925 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4926 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4927 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4928 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4929 based on some information from the request.
4930
4931 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4932
4933http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4934
4935 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4936 inline.
4937
4938 Arguments:
4939 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4940 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4941 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4942 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4943 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4944 (request and response)
4945 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4946 processing
4947 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4948 processing
4949 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4950 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4951 and '_'.
4952
4953 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4954 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004955
4956 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004957 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004958
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004959http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004960
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004961 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4962 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4963 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4964 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4965 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4966 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4967 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4968 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4969 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4970 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4971 action.
4972 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4973 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4974 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4975 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4976 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004978http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4979http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4980http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004982 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4983 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4984 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4985 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4986 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4987 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4988
4989http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4990
4991 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4992 about <var-name>.
4993
4994 Example:
4995 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4996
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004997
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004998http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4999 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5000
5001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5002 yes | no | yes | yes
5003
5004 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005005 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5006 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5007 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005008
5009 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5010
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005011 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5012 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5013 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5014 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5015 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5016 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5017 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5018 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5019 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5020 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005021
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005022 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5023 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5024 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5025 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5026 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5027 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5028 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5029 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005030
5031 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5032 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5033 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5034 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5035 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5036 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5037 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5038 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5039 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5040 downsides of rare connection failures.
5041
5042 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5043 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5044 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5045 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5046 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5047 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005048 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005049 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5050 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5051 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5052 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5053 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5054
5055 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005056 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5057 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5058 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005059
5060 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005061 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005062
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005063 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5064 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005065
5066 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5067 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5068 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5069
5070 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5071 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5072 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5073
5074 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5075
5076
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005077http-send-name-header [<header>]
5078 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5079
5080 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5081 yes | no | yes | yes
5082
5083 Arguments :
5084
5085 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5086
5087 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005088 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005089 is added with the header string proved.
5090
5091 See also : "server"
5092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005093id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005094 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 no | yes | yes | yes
5097 Arguments : none
5098
5099 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5100 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5101 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005102
5103
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005104ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5105 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5106 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005107 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005108
5109 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5110 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5111 and running).
5112
5113 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5114 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5115 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005116 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005117 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5118
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005119 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5120 "unless" condition is met.
5121
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005122 Example:
5123 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5124 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5125 ignore-persist if url_static
5126
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005127 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5128
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005129load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5130 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5131 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5132 yes | no | yes | yes
5133
5134 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5135 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5136 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005137 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005138 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5139 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5140 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5141 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5142
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005143 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005144 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005145 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005146
5147 Arguments:
5148 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5149 named "server-state-file".
5150
5151 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5152 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5153 name is used as a file name.
5154
5155 none don't load any stat for this backend
5156
5157 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005158 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5159 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5160 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005161 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005162 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005163
5164 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5165 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5166
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005167 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005168
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005169 global
5170 stats socket /tmp/socket
5171 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005172
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005173 defaults
5174 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005175
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005176 backend bk
5177 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5178 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005179
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005180
5181 Then one can run :
5182
5183 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5184
5185 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5186
5187 1
5188 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5189 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5190 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5191
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005192 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005193
5194 global
5195 stats socket /tmp/socket
5196 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5197
5198 defaults
5199 load-server-state-from-file local
5200
5201 backend bk
5202 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5203 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5204
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005205
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005206 Then one can run :
5207
5208 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5209
5210 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5211
5212 1
5213 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5214 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5215 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5216
5217 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5218 "show servers state"
5219
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005220
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005221log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005222log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005223no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005224 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5226 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005227
5228 Prefix :
5229 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5230 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5231 prefix does not allow arguments.
5232
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005233 Arguments :
5234 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5235 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5236 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5237 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5238 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5239 parameter.
5240
5241 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5242 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5243
5244 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5245 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5246 standard syslog port).
5247
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005248 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5249 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5250 standard syslog port).
5251
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005252 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5253 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5254 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005255 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005256
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005257 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5258 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5259 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5260 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5261 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5262 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5263 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5264 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5265 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5266 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5267 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5268 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5269 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5270 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5271 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5272 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005273 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5274 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005275
5276 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5277 and "fd@2", see above.
5278
5279 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5280 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005281
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005282 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5283 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5284 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5285 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5286 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5287 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5288 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5289 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5290 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5291 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005292 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005293
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005294 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5295 one of the following :
5296
5297 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5298 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5299
5300 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5301 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5302
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005303 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5304 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5305 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5306 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5307 systemd logger consumes.
5308
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005309 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5310 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5311 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5312 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5313
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005314 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5315
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005316 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5317 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5318 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5319
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005320 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5321 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5322 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5323 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005324
5325 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5326 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5327 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005328 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5329 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5330 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5331 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5332 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005333
5334 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5335
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005336 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5337 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5338 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005339
5340 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5341 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5342 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5343 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5344
5345 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5346 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005347
5348 Example :
5349 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005350 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5351 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5352 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005353 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5354 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005355 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005356
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005357
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005358log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005359 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5360 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5361 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005362
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005363 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5364 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5365 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5366 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5367 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005368
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005369 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5370 "option httplog" directives.
5371
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005372log-format-sd <string>
5373 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5374 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5375 yes | yes | yes | no
5376
5377 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5378 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5379 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5380 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5381 which covers the log format string in depth.
5382
5383 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5384 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5385
5386 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5387 log format to "rfc5424".
5388
5389 Example :
5390 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5391
5392
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005393log-tag <string>
5394 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5396 yes | yes | yes | yes
5397
5398 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5399 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5400 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5401 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5402 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5403 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5404 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5405 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5406 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005407
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005408max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5409 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5410 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5411 yes | no | yes | yes
5412
5413 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5414 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5415 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5416 servers.
5417
5418 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5419 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5420 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5421 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5422 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005423 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005424 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5425 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5426 picking a different server.
5427
5428 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5429 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5430 even if they have to be queued.
5431
5432 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5433 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5434
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005435max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5436 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5437 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5438 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005439
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005440maxconn <conns>
5441 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5443 yes | yes | yes | no
5444 Arguments :
5445 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5446 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5447 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5448 closes.
5449
5450 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5451 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5452 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5453 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005454 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5455 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5456 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5457 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005458
5459 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5460 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5461 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5462
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005463 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5464
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005465 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5466
5467
5468mode { tcp|http|health }
5469 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5471 yes | yes | yes | yes
5472 Arguments :
5473 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5474 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5475 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5476 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5477
5478 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5479 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5480 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5481 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5482 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5483
5484 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005485 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5486 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5487 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5488 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5489 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5490 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5491 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005492
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005493 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5494 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5495 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005496
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005497 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005498 defaults http_instances
5499 mode http
5500
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005501 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005502
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005503
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005504monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005505 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5507 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005508 Arguments :
5509 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5510 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005511 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005512 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5513 backend and its backup.
5514
5515 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5516 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5517 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5518 servers in a list of backends.
5519
5520 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5521 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5522 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5523 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5524 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5525 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5526 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005527 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5528 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005529
5530 Example:
5531 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005532 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005533 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5534 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5535 monitor-uri /site_alive
5536 monitor fail if site_dead
5537
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005538 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005539
5540
5541monitor-net <source>
5542 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5544 yes | yes | yes | no
5545 Arguments :
5546 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5547 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5548 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5549 followed by a mask.
5550
5551 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5552 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005553 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005554 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5555
5556 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5557 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5558 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5559 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005560 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5561 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5562 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005563
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005564 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5565 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5566 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5567 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5568 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5569 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005570
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005571 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5572 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005573
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005574 Example :
5575 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5576 frontend www
5577 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5578
5579 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5580
5581
5582monitor-uri <uri>
5583 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5585 yes | yes | yes | no
5586 Arguments :
5587 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5588 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5589
5590 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5591 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5592 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5593 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5594 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5595 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5596 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5597 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5598
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005599 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5600 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5601 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5602 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5603 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5604 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5605 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5606 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005607
5608 Example :
5609 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5610 frontend www
5611 mode http
5612 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5613
5614 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5615
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005616
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005617option abortonclose
5618no option abortonclose
5619 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5621 yes | no | yes | yes
5622 Arguments : none
5623
5624 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5625 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5626 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5627 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005628 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005629 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5630 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5631 encountered while delivering the response.
5632
5633 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5634 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5635 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5636 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5637 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5638 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005639 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005640 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005641 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005642 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5643 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5644 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5645
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005646 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5647 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005648 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5649 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5650 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5651 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5652 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5653 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005654 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005655
5656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5658
5659 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5660
5661
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005662option accept-invalid-http-request
5663no option accept-invalid-http-request
5664 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5666 yes | yes | yes | no
5667 Arguments : none
5668
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005669 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005670 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005671 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005672 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5673 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5674 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5675 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5676 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005677 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5678 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5679 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5680 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005681 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005682 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005683 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5684 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5685 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005686
5687 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5688 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5689 been confirmed.
5690
5691 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5692 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005693 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5694 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005695 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5696
5697 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5698 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5699
5700 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5701 stats socket.
5702
5703
5704option accept-invalid-http-response
5705no option accept-invalid-http-response
5706 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5708 yes | no | yes | yes
5709 Arguments : none
5710
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005711 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005712 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005713 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005714 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5715 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5716 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5717 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5718 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005719 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5720 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5721 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005722
5723 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5724 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5725 been confirmed.
5726
5727 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5728 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5729 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5730 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5731
5732 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5733 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5734
5735 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5736 stats socket.
5737
5738
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005739option allbackups
5740no option allbackups
5741 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | no | yes | yes
5744 Arguments : none
5745
5746 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5747 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5748 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5749 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5750 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5751 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5752 order between the backup servers anymore.
5753
5754 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5755 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5756
5757 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5758 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5759
5760
5761option checkcache
5762no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005763 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5765 yes | no | yes | yes
5766 Arguments : none
5767
5768 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5769 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005770 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005771 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5772 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005773 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005774
5775 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005776 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005777 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005778 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5779 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005780 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005781 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005782 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5783 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005784 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005785 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5786 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005787 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005788 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5789 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5790 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5791 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5792 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5793 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5794 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5795 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5796 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5797
5798 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005799 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005800 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005801 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005802 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5803
5804 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5805 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005806 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005807 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005808
5809 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5810 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5811
5812
5813option clitcpka
5814no option clitcpka
5815 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5817 yes | yes | yes | no
5818 Arguments : none
5819
5820 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5821 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005822 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005823 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5824
5825 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5826 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5827 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5828 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5829
5830 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5831 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5832 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5833 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5834 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5835
5836 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5837
5838 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5839 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5840 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5841
5842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5844
5845 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5846
5847
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005848option contstats
5849 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5851 yes | yes | yes | no
5852 Arguments : none
5853
5854 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5855 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5856 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5857 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005858 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5859 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5860 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5861 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5862 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005863
5864
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005865option dontlog-normal
5866no option dontlog-normal
5867 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5869 yes | yes | yes | no
5870 Arguments : none
5871
5872 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5873 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5874 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5875 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5876 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5877 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5878 logged.
5879
5880 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5881 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5882 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005884 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005885 logging.
5886
5887
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005888option dontlognull
5889no option dontlognull
5890 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5892 yes | yes | yes | no
5893 Arguments : none
5894
5895 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5896 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5897 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5898 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5899 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5900 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005901 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5902 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5903 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005904
5905 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005906 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005907 would not be logged.
5908
5909 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5910 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5911
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005912 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5913 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005914
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005915
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005916option forceclose (deprecated)
5917no option forceclose (deprecated)
5918 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005919
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005920 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005921
5922
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005923option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005924 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5926 yes | yes | yes | yes
5927 Arguments :
5928 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5929 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005930 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005931 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005932
5933 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5934 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5935 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5936 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5937 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5938 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5939 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005940 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5941 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5942 possible that the client has already brought one.
5943
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005944 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005945 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005946 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005947 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005948 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005949 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005950
5951 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5952 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5953 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5954 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5955 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5956 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5957 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5958
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005959 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5960 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5961 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5962 are under the control of the end-user.
5963
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005964 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005965 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5966 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005967 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5968 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5969 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005970
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005971 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005972 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5973 frontend www
5974 mode http
5975 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5976
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005977 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5978 backend www
5979 mode http
5980 option forwardfor header X-Client
5981
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005982 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005983 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005984
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005985
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005986option http-buffer-request
5987no option http-buffer-request
5988 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5990 yes | yes | yes | yes
5991 Arguments : none
5992
5993 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5994 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5995 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5996 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5997 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5998 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5999 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6000 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006001 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006002 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6003 default.
6004
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006005 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006006
6007
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006008option http-ignore-probes
6009no option http-ignore-probes
6010 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6012 yes | yes | yes | no
6013 Arguments : none
6014
6015 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6016 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6017 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6018 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6019 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6020 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6021 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6022 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6023 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006024 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6025 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006026 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6027
6028 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6029 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6030 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6031 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6032 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6033 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6034 are often the only way to detect them.
6035
6036 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6037 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6038
6039 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6040
6041
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006042option http-keep-alive
6043no option http-keep-alive
6044 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6046 yes | yes | yes | yes
6047 Arguments : none
6048
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006049 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6050 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006051 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6052 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6053 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6054 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6055 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006056
6057 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6058 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006059 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6060 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6061 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6062 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6063 situations where this option may be useful :
6064
6065 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006066 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006067
6068 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6069 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6070
6071 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6072 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6073 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6074 request.
6075
6076 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6077 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006078 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6079 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6080 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006081
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006082 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6083 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6084 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6085 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6086 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6087 not set.
6088
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006089 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006090 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6091 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006092
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006093 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006094 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006095 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006096
6097
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006098option http-no-delay
6099no option http-no-delay
6100 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6102 yes | yes | yes | yes
6103 Arguments : none
6104
6105 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6106 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6107 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6108 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6109 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6110 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6111 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6112 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6113 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6114 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6115 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6116 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6117 affected.
6118
6119 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6120 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6121 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6122 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6123 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6124 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6125 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6126 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6127 latency environments.
6128
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006129 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6130
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006131
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006132option http-pretend-keepalive
6133no option http-pretend-keepalive
6134 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006136 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006137 Arguments : none
6138
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006139 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006140 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6141 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6142 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6143 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6144 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6145 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6146 consider the response complete.
6147
6148 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6149 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6150 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6151 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006152 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006153 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6154
6155 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6156 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6157 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6158 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6159 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6160 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6161 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6162
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006163 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6164 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6165 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6166 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6167 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6168 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006169
6170 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6171 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6172
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006173 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006174 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006175
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006176
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006177option http-server-close
6178no option http-server-close
6179 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6181 yes | yes | yes | yes
6182 Arguments : none
6183
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006184 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6185 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6186 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6187 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006188 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6189 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6190 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6191 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6192 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6193 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6194 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6195 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6196 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6197 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6198 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006199
6200 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6201 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6202 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6203 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006204 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6205 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006206
6207 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6208 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006209 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6210 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6211 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006212
6213 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6214 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6215
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006216 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6217 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006218
6219
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006220option http-tunnel
6221no option http-tunnel
6222 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006224 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006225 Arguments : none
6226
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006227 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6228 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6229 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6230 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006231 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006232
6233 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006234 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006235 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6236 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6237 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6238 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6239 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6240 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6241 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006242
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006243 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6244 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6245 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6246 backend.
6247
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006248 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6249 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6250
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006251 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6252 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006253
6254
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006255option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006256no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006257 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6259 yes | yes | yes | no
6260 Arguments : none
6261
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006262 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006263 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6264 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6265 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6266 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6267 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6268 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6269
6270 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6271 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006272 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6273 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6274 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006275
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006276 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6277 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6278 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6279 front of an existing proxy.
6280
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006281 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6282
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006283 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006284
6285
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006286option http-use-htx
6287no option http-use-htx
6288 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6290 yes | yes | yes | yes
6291 Arguments : none
6292
6293 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6294 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6295 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6296 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6297 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6298 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6299 representation.
6300
6301 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6302 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6303 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6304 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6305 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6306 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6307 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6308 other side's version.
6309
6310 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6311 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6312 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6313 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6314 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6315
6316 See also : "mode http"
6317
6318
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006319option httpchk
6320option httpchk <uri>
6321option httpchk <method> <uri>
6322option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6323 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6325 yes | no | yes | yes
6326 Arguments :
6327 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6328 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6329 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6330 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6331 ones.
6332
6333 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6334 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6335 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6336
6337 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6338 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6339 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6340 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6341 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6342
6343 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6344 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6345 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6346 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6347 the lack of any response.
6348
6349 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6350
6351 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6352 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6353 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6354
6355 Examples :
6356 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6357 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6358 backend https_relay
6359 mode tcp
6360 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6361 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6362
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006363 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6364 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6365 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006366
6367
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006368option httpclose
6369no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006370 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6372 yes | yes | yes | yes
6373 Arguments : none
6374
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006375 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6376 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6377 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6378 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006379 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006380
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006381 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6382 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6383 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6384 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6385 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006386
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006387 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6388 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6389 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006390
6391 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6392 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006393 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006394 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6395 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6396 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006397
6398 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6399 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6400
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006401 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006402
6403
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006404option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006405 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006407 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006408 Arguments :
6409 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6410 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6411 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006412 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006413 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006414
6415 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6416 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6417 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6418 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6419 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6420 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6421 ports.
6422
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006423 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6424 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006425
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006426 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006428 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006429
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006430
6431option http_proxy
6432no option http_proxy
6433 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6435 yes | yes | yes | yes
6436 Arguments : none
6437
6438 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6439 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6440 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6441 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6442 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6443
6444 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6445 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006446 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6447 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006448
6449 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6450 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6451
6452 Example :
6453 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6454 backend direct_forward
6455 option httpclose
6456 option http_proxy
6457
6458 See also : "option httpclose"
6459
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006460
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006461option independent-streams
6462no option independent-streams
6463 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6465 yes | yes | yes | yes
6466 Arguments : none
6467
6468 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6469 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6470 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6471 receive data or not.
6472
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006473 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006474 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6475 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6476 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6477 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6478 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6479 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6480 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6481 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6482 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6483 socket buffers.
6484
6485 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6486 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6487 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6488 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6489 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6490
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006491 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006492 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6493 deprecated.
6494
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006495 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006496
6497
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006498option ldap-check
6499 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6501 yes | no | yes | yes
6502 Arguments : none
6503
6504 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6505 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6506 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6507 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6508
6509 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6510 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6511
6512 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6513 configure it.
6514
6515 Example :
6516 option ldap-check
6517
6518 See also : "option httpchk"
6519
6520
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006521option external-check
6522 Use external processes for server health checks
6523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6524 yes | no | yes | yes
6525
6526 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6527 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6528 command".
6529
6530 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6531
6532 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6533
6534
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006535option log-health-checks
6536no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006537 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6539 yes | no | yes | yes
6540 Arguments : none
6541
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006542 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6543 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6544 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006545
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006546 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6547 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6548 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6549 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6550 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6551
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006552 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006553 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006554
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006555 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6556 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6557 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006558
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006559
6560option log-separate-errors
6561no option log-separate-errors
6562 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6564 yes | yes | yes | no
6565 Arguments : none
6566
6567 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6568 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6569 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6570 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6571 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6572 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6573 provides very important information.
6574
6575 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6576 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6577 error logs.
6578
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006579 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006580 logging.
6581
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006582
6583option logasap
6584no option logasap
6585 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6587 yes | yes | yes | no
6588 Arguments : none
6589
6590 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6591 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6592 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6593 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6594 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6595 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6596 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006597 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006598 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6599 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6600
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006601 Examples :
6602 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6603 mode http
6604 option httplog
6605 option logasap
6606 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6607
6608 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6609 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6610 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6611 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006613 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006614 logging.
6615
6616
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006617option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006618 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6620 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006621 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006622 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6623 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006624 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006625
6626 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6627 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006628 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006629 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6630 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6631 in the MySQL table, like this :
6632
6633 USE mysql;
6634 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6635 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6636
6637 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006638 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006639 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6640 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6641 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6642 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6643 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6644 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6645 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6646
6647 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6648 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006649
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006650 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006651
6652 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6653 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6654 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6655 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006656 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6657 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006658
6659 See also: "option httpchk"
6660
6661
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006662option nolinger
6663no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006664 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6666 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006667 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006668
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006669 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006670 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6671 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6672 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6673 connections.
6674
6675 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6676 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6677 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6678 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6679 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6680 this too.
6681
6682 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6683 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6684 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6685
6686 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6687 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6688 for servers.
6689
6690 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6691 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6692
6693
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006694option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6695 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6697 yes | yes | yes | yes
6698 Arguments :
6699 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6700 matching <network>
6701 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6702 header name.
6703
6704 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6705 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6706 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6707 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6708 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6709 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6710 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6711 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6712 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6713 possible that the client has already brought one.
6714
6715 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6716 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6717 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6718 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6719 header and requires different one.
6720
6721 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6722 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6723 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6724 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6725 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6726 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6727 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6728
6729 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6730 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6731 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6732 both are defined.
6733
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006734 Examples :
6735 # Original Destination address
6736 frontend www
6737 mode http
6738 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6739
6740 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6741 backend www
6742 mode http
6743 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6744
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006745 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006746
6747
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006748option persist
6749no option persist
6750 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6752 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006753 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006754
6755 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6756 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6757 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6758 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6759 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6760 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6761 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6762 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6763 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6764 redirected to another valid server.
6765
6766 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6767 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6768
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006769 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006770
6771
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006772option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6773 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6775 yes | no | yes | yes
6776 Arguments :
6777 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6778 PostgreSQL server.
6779
6780 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6781 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6782 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6783 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6784
6785 See also: "option httpchk"
6786
6787
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006788option prefer-last-server
6789no option prefer-last-server
6790 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6791 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6792 yes | no | yes | yes
6793 Arguments : none
6794
6795 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6796 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6797 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6798 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6799 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6800 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6801 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6802 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6803 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006804 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6805 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006806 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6807 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6808 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006809 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6810 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6811 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006812
6813 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6814 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6815
6816 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6817
6818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006819option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006820option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006821no option redispatch
6822 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6824 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006825 Arguments :
6826 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6827 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6828 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006829 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006830 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006831 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006832 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6833 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6834 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006836
6837 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6838 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6839 be able to access the service anymore.
6840
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006841 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6842 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006843
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006844 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006845 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6846 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006848 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6849 "redisp" keywords.
6850
6851 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6852 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6853
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006854 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006855
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006856
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006857option redis-check
6858 Use redis health checks for server testing
6859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6860 yes | no | yes | yes
6861 Arguments : none
6862
6863 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6864 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6865 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6866 find the "+PONG" response message.
6867
6868 Example :
6869 option redis-check
6870
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006871 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006872
6873
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006874option smtpchk
6875option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6876 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6878 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006879 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006880 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006881 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006882 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6883
6884 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6885 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6886 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6887
6888 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6889 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6890 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6891 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6892 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6893 dead server.
6894
6895 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6896 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006897 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006898 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6899
6900 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6901 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6902 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6903 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006904 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006905
6906 Example :
6907 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6908
6909 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006912option socket-stats
6913no option socket-stats
6914
6915 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6917 yes | yes | yes | no
6918
6919 Arguments : none
6920
6921
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006922option splice-auto
6923no option splice-auto
6924 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6926 yes | yes | yes | yes
6927 Arguments : none
6928
6929 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6930 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006931 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006932 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006933 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006934 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6935 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6936 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6937 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6938
6939 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6940 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6941 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6942 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6943 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6944 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6945 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6946 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6947 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6948 keyword.
6949
6950 Example :
6951 option splice-auto
6952
6953 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6954 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6955
6956 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6957 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6958
6959
6960option splice-request
6961no option splice-request
6962 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6964 yes | yes | yes | yes
6965 Arguments : none
6966
6967 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006968 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006969 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6970 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6971 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6972 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6973
6974 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6975
6976 Example :
6977 option splice-request
6978
6979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6981
6982 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6983 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6984
6985
6986option splice-response
6987no option splice-response
6988 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6990 yes | yes | yes | yes
6991 Arguments : none
6992
6993 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006994 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006995 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6996 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6997 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6998 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6999
7000 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7001
7002 Example :
7003 option splice-response
7004
7005 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7006 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7007
7008 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7009 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7010
7011
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007012option spop-check
7013 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7015 no | no | no | yes
7016 Arguments : none
7017
7018 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7019 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7020 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7021 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7022
7023 Example :
7024 option spop-check
7025
7026 See also : "option httpchk"
7027
7028
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007029option srvtcpka
7030no option srvtcpka
7031 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7033 yes | no | yes | yes
7034 Arguments : none
7035
7036 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7037 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007038 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007039 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7040
7041 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7042 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7043 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7044 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7045
7046 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7047 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7048 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7049 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7050 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7051
7052 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7053
7054 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7055 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7056 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7057
7058 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7059 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7060
7061 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7062
7063
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007064option ssl-hello-chk
7065 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7067 yes | no | yes | yes
7068 Arguments : none
7069
7070 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7071 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7072 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7073 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7074 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7075 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7076 hello message.
7077
7078 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7079 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7080 messages, which is appreciable.
7081
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007082 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7083 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7084 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007085
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007086 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7087
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007088
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007089option tcp-check
7090 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7091 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7092 yes | no | yes | yes
7093
7094 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7095 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7096
7097 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7098 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7099 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7100
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007101 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007102 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7103 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7104 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7105 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7106 only.
7107
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007108 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007109 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7110 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7111 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7112 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7113
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007114 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007115 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7116 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007117 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007118 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7119 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7120 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7121 the respective protocols.
7122 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007123 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007124
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007125 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7126 script.
7127
7128 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7129 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7130 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7131 The "comment" is of course optional.
7132
7133
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007134 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007135 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007136 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007137 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007139 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007140 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007141 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007142
7143 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7144 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007145 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007146 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007147 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007148 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007149 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007150 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007151 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7152 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007153 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007154 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7155 tcp-check expect string +OK
7156
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007157 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007158 (send many headers before analyzing)
7159 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007160 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007161 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7162 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7163 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7164 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007165 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007166
7167
7168 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7169
7170
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007171option tcp-smart-accept
7172no option tcp-smart-accept
7173 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7175 yes | yes | yes | no
7176 Arguments : none
7177
7178 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7179 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7180 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7181 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7182 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7183 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7184
7185 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7186 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7187 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7188 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7189
7190 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7191 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7192 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007193 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007194
7195 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7196 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7197 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7198
7199 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7200 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7201 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7202
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007203 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7204
7205
7206option tcp-smart-connect
7207no option tcp-smart-connect
7208 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7210 yes | no | yes | yes
7211 Arguments : none
7212
7213 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7214 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7215 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7216 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7217 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7218
7219 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7220 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7221 complex.
7222
7223 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7224 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7225 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7226
7227 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7228 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7229
7230 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7231
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007232
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007233option tcpka
7234 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7236 yes | yes | yes | yes
7237 Arguments : none
7238
7239 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7240 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007241 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007242 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7243
7244 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7245 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7246 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7247 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7248
7249 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7250 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7251 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7252 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7253 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7254
7255 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7256
7257 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7258 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7259 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7260 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7261 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7262 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7263 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7264 backends.
7265
7266 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7267
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007268
7269option tcplog
7270 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007272 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007273 Arguments : none
7274
7275 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7276 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7277 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7278 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7279 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7280 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7281 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7282 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7283
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007284 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007286 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007287
7288
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007289option transparent
7290no option transparent
7291 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007293 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007294 Arguments : none
7295
7296 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7297 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7298 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7299 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7300 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7301 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7302 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7303 appropriate server.
7304
7305 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7306 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7307
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007308 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007309 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007310
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007311
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007312external-check command <command>
7313 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7315 yes | no | yes | yes
7316
7317 Arguments :
7318 <command> is the external command to run
7319
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007320 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7321
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007322 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007323
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007324 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7325 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7326 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7327 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7328 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7329 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007330
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007331 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7332
7333 Environment variables :
7334 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7335 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7336
7337 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7338
7339 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7340
7341 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7342 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7343 for a UNIX socket).
7344
7345 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7346
7347 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7348
7349 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7350
7351 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7352
7353 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7354
7355 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7356 socket).
7357
7358 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7359 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7360
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007361 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7362 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7363 failed.
7364
7365 Example :
7366 external-check command /bin/true
7367
7368 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7369
7370
7371external-check path <path>
7372 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7374 yes | no | yes | yes
7375
7376 Arguments :
7377 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7378
7379 The default path is "".
7380
7381 Example :
7382 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7383
7384 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7385 "external-check command"
7386
7387
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007388persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007389persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007390 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7392 yes | no | yes | yes
7393 Arguments :
7394 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007395 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7396 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007397
7398 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7399 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007400 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007401 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7402 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7403 forwarded to this server.
7404
7405 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7406 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7407 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007408 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007409 a single "listen" section.
7410
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007411 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7412 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7413 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7414
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007415 Example :
7416 listen tse-farm
7417 bind :3389
7418 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7419 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7420 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7421 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7422 persist rdp-cookie
7423 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007424 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007425 balance rdp-cookie
7426 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7427 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7428
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007429 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7430 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007431
7432
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007433rate-limit sessions <rate>
7434 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7436 yes | yes | yes | no
7437 Arguments :
7438 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7439 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7440
7441 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7442 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7443 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7444 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7445 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7446 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7447
7448 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7449 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7450 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7451 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7452
7453 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7454 listen smtp
7455 mode tcp
7456 bind :25
7457 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007458 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007459
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007460 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7461 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7462 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007463
7464 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7465
7466
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007467redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7468redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7469redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007470 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7472 no | yes | yes | yes
7473
7474 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007475 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007476
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007477 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007478 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007479 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7480 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7481 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007482
7483 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7484 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7485 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7486 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7487 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007488 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7489 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7490 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7491 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007492
7493 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7494 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7495 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7496 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7497 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7498 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007499 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007500 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007501 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7502 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7503 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007504
7505 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007506 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7507 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7508 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007509 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007510 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7511 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7512 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7513 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007514
7515 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007516 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007517
7518 - "drop-query"
7519 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7520 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7521 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7522 with a location-type redirect.
7523
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007524 - "append-slash"
7525 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7526 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7527 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7528 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7529
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007530 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7531 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7532 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7533 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7534 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7535 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7536 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7537
7538 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7539 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7540 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7541 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7542 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7543 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7544 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007545
7546 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7547 acl clear dst_port 80
7548 acl secure dst_port 8080
7549 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007550 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007551 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007552 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7553
7554 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007555 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7556 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7557 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007558 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007559
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007560 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7561 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7562 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7563
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007564 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007565 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007566
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007567 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007568 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7569 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7570 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007572 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007573
7574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007575redisp (deprecated)
7576redispatch (deprecated)
7577 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7579 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007580 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007581
7582 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7583 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7584 be able to access the service anymore.
7585
7586 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7587 redistribute them to a working server.
7588
7589 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7590 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7591 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007593 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7594 "option redispatch" instead.
7595
7596 See also : "option redispatch"
7597
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007598
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007599reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007600 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7602 no | yes | yes | yes
7603 Arguments :
7604 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7605 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007606 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007607
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007608 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7609 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7610
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007611 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7612 the last header of an HTTP request.
7613
7614 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7615 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7616 responses.
7617
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007618 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7619 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7620 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7621
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007622 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7623 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007624
7625
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007626reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7627reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007628 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7630 no | yes | yes | yes
7631 Arguments :
7632 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7633 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7634 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7635 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7636 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7637 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7638 ignores case.
7639
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007640 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7641 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7642
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007643 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7644 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7645 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7646 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007647 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007648
7649 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7650 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7651
7652 Example :
7653 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7654 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7655 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7656
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007657 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7658 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007659
7660
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007661reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7662reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007663 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7665 no | yes | yes | yes
7666 Arguments :
7667 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7668 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7669 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7670 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7671 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7672 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7673
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007674 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7675 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7676
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007677 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7678 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7679 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7680 next servers.
7681
7682 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7683 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7684 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7685
7686 Example :
7687 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7688 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7689 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7690
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007691 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7692 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007693
7694
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007695reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7696reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007697 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7699 no | yes | yes | yes
7700 Arguments :
7701 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7702 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7703 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7704 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7705 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7706 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7707 case.
7708
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007709 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7710 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7711
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007712 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7713 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7714 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7715 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007716 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007717
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007718 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007719 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007720 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007721
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007722 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7723 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7724
7725 Example :
7726 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7727 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7728 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7729
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007730 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7731 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007732
7733
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007734reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7735reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007736 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7738 no | yes | yes | yes
7739 Arguments :
7740 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7741 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7742 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7743 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7744 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7745 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7746 case.
7747
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007748 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7749 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7750
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007751 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7752 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7753 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7754 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7755
7756 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7757 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7758
7759 Example :
7760 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7761 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7762 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7763 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7764
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007765 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7766 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007767
7768
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007769reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7770reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007771 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7773 no | yes | yes | yes
7774 Arguments :
7775 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7776 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7777 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7778 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7779 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7780 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7781
7782 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7783 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7784 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7785 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007786 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007787
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007788 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7789 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7790
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007791 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7792 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7793 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7794
7795 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7796 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7797 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7798 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7799 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7800
7801 Example :
7802 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007803 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007804 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7805 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7806
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007807 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7808 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007809
7810
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007811reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7812reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007813 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7815 no | yes | yes | yes
7816 Arguments :
7817 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7818 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7819 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7820 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7821 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7822 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7823 ignores case.
7824
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007825 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7826 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7827
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007828 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7829 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007830 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7831 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7832 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007833 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7834 not set.
7835
7836 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7837 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7838 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7839 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7840 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7841
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007842 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007843 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007844 # block all others.
7845 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7846 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7847
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007848 # block bad guys
7849 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7850 reqitarpit . if badguys
7851
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007852 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7853 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007854
7855
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007856retries <value>
7857 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7858 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7859 yes | no | yes | yes
7860 Arguments :
7861 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7862 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7863 default value is 3.
7864
7865 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7866 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7867 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7868
7869 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007870 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7871 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007872
7873 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7874 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7875
7876 See also : "option redispatch"
7877
7878
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007879rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007880 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7882 no | yes | yes | yes
7883 Arguments :
7884 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7885 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007886 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007887
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007888 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7889 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7890
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007891 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7892 the last header of an HTTP response.
7893
7894 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7895 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7896 responses.
7897
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007898 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7899 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007900
7901
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007902rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7903rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007904 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7906 no | yes | yes | yes
7907 Arguments :
7908 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7909 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7910 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7911 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7912 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7913 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7914 ignores case.
7915
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007916 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7917 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7918
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007919 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7920 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007921 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007922 client.
7923
7924 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7925 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7926 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7927
7928 Example :
7929 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007930 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007931
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007932 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7933 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007934
7935
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007936rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7937rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007938 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7940 no | yes | yes | yes
7941 Arguments :
7942 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7943 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7944 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7945 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7946 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7947 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7948 ignores case.
7949
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007950 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7951 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7952
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007953 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7954 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7955 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7956 case-sensitive.
7957
7958 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007959 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7960 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7961 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007962
7963 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7964 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7965
7966 Example :
7967 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7968 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7969
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007970 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7971 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007972
7973
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007974rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7975rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007976 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7978 no | yes | yes | yes
7979 Arguments :
7980 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7981 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7982 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7983 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7984 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7985 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7986 ignores case.
7987
7988 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7989 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7990 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7991 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007992 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007993
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007994 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7995 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7996
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007997 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7998 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7999 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8000
8001 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8002 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8003 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8004 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8005 are not case-sensitive.
8006
8007 Example :
8008 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8009 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8010
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008011 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8012 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008013
8014
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008015server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008016 Declare a server in a backend
8017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8018 no | no | yes | yes
8019 Arguments :
8020 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008021 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008022 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008023
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008024 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8025 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8026 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8027 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008028 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8029 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8030 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8031 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8032 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008033 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8034 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8035 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8036 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8037 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8038 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8039 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008040 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008041 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8042 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8043 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8044 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8045 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8046 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008047 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8048 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008049 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8050 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008051
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008052 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008053 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8054 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8055 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8056 adding this value to the client's port.
8057
8058 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8059 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008060 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008061
8062 Examples :
8063 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8064 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008065 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008066 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8067 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8068 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008069
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008070 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8071 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8072 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8073 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8074 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8075
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008076 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8077 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008078
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008079server-state-file-name [<file>]
8080 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8081 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8082 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8083 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8084 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8085 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8086
8087 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8088 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8089
8090 global
8091 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8092
8093 backend bk
8094 load-server-state-from-file
8095
8096 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8097 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008098
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008099server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8100 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8101 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8103 no | no | yes | yes
8104
8105 Arguments:
8106 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8107
8108 <num | range>
8109 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8110 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8111 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8112 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8113
8114 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8115
8116 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8117
8118 <params*>
8119 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8120 keyword.
8121
8122 Examples:
8123 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8124 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8125 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8126
8127 # or
8128 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8129
8130 # would be equivalent to:
8131 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8132 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8133 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8134
8135
8136
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008137source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008138source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008139source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008140 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8142 yes | no | yes | yes
8143 Arguments :
8144 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8145 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008146
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008147 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008148 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8149 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8150 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8151 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8152 supported prefixes are :
8153 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8154 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8155 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008156 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008157 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8158 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008159
8160 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8161 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008162 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8163 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8164 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008165
8166 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8167 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8168 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8169 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8170 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8171 <addr>.
8172
8173 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8174 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8175 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8176 port.
8177
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008178 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8179 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8180 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8181 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008182 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008183 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8184 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8185 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8186 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8187 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8188 HTTP header.
8189
8190 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8191 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008192 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008193 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8194 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8195 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8196 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8197 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8198 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8199 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8200
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008201 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8202 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8203 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8204 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8205 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8206 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8207
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008208 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8209 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8210 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8211 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8212
8213 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8214 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8215 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8216 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8217 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8218 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8219
8220 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8221 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8222 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8223 there are two methods :
8224
8225 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8226 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8227 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8228 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8229 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8230 of the client ranges may be used.
8231
8232 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8233 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8234 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8235 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8236 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8237 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8238 same session.
8239
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008240 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8241 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8242 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008243 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008244
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008245 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8246
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008247 Examples :
8248 backend private
8249 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8250 source 192.168.1.200
8251
8252 backend transparent_ssl1
8253 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8254 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8255
8256 backend transparent_ssl2
8257 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8258 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8259 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8260
8261 backend transparent_ssl3
8262 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8263 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8264 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8265
8266 backend transparent_smtp
8267 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8268 # with Tproxy version 4.
8269 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8270
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008271 backend transparent_http
8272 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8273 # proxy.
8274 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008276 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008277 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8278
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008279
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008280srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8281 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8283 yes | no | yes | yes
8284 Arguments :
8285 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8286 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8287 as explained at the top of this document.
8288
8289 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8290 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8291 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8292 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8293 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8294 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8295 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8296
8297 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8298 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8299 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8300 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8301 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008302 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008303 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008304 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008305
8306 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8307 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8308 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8309 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8310 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8311 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8312
8313 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8314 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8315
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008316 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8317 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008318
8319
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008320stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8321 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008323 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008324
8325 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8326 matched.
8327
8328 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8329 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8330
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008331 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8332 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008333 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008334
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008335 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8336 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8337 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8338 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008339
8340 Example :
8341 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8342 backend stats_localhost
8343 stats enable
8344 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8345
8346 Example :
8347 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8348 backend stats_auth
8349 stats enable
8350 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8351 stats admin if TRUE
8352
8353 Example :
8354 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8355 userlist stats-auth
8356 group admin users admin
8357 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8358 group readonly users haproxy
8359 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8360
8361 backend stats_auth
8362 stats enable
8363 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8364 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8365 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8366 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8367
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008368 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8369 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8370 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008371
8372
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008373stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8374 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008376 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008377 Arguments :
8378 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8379
8380 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8381
8382 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8383 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8384 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8385 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8386 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8387 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8388
8389 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8390 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8391 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008392 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008393
8394 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8395 report using "stats scope".
8396
8397 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8398 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8399 unobvious parameters.
8400
8401 Example :
8402 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8403 backend public_www
8404 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8405 stats enable
8406 stats hide-version
8407 stats scope .
8408 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008409 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008410 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8411 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8412
8413 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8414 backend private_monitoring
8415 stats enable
8416 stats uri /admin?stats
8417 stats refresh 5s
8418
8419 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8420
8421
8422stats enable
8423 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008425 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008426 Arguments : none
8427
8428 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8429 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8430 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8431 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8432 - stats auth : no authentication
8433 - stats scope : no restriction
8434
8435 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8436 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8437 unobvious parameters.
8438
8439 Example :
8440 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8441 backend public_www
8442 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8443 stats enable
8444 stats hide-version
8445 stats scope .
8446 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008447 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008448 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8449 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8450
8451 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8452 backend private_monitoring
8453 stats enable
8454 stats uri /admin?stats
8455 stats refresh 5s
8456
8457 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8458
8459
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008460stats hide-version
8461 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008463 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008464 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008465
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008466 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8467 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8468 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8469 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8470 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8471 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008473 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8474 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8475 unobvious parameters.
8476
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008477 Example :
8478 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8479 backend public_www
8480 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008481 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008482 stats hide-version
8483 stats scope .
8484 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008485 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008486 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8487 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008488
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008489 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8490 backend private_monitoring
8491 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008492 stats uri /admin?stats
8493 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008494
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008495 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008496
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008497
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008498stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8499 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8500 Access control for statistics
8501
8502 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8503 no | no | yes | yes
8504
8505 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8506 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8507 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8508 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8509 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8510 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8511
8512 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8513 instance.
8514
8515 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8516 about ACL usage.
8517
8518
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008519stats realm <realm>
8520 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008522 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008523 Arguments :
8524 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8525 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8526 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8527
8528 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8529 using a backslash ('\').
8530
8531 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8532 only related to authentication.
8533
8534 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8535 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8536 unobvious parameters.
8537
8538 Example :
8539 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8540 backend public_www
8541 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8542 stats enable
8543 stats hide-version
8544 stats scope .
8545 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008546 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008547 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8548 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8549
8550 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8551 backend private_monitoring
8552 stats enable
8553 stats uri /admin?stats
8554 stats refresh 5s
8555
8556 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8557
8558
8559stats refresh <delay>
8560 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008562 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008563 Arguments :
8564 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8565 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8566 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8567 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8568 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8569 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8570
8571 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8572 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8573 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8574 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8575
8576 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8577 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8578 unobvious parameters.
8579
8580 Example :
8581 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8582 backend public_www
8583 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8584 stats enable
8585 stats hide-version
8586 stats scope .
8587 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008588 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008589 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8590 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8591
8592 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8593 backend private_monitoring
8594 stats enable
8595 stats uri /admin?stats
8596 stats refresh 5s
8597
8598 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8599
8600
8601stats scope { <name> | "." }
8602 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008604 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008605 Arguments :
8606 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8607 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8608 section in which the statement appears.
8609
8610 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8611 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8612 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8613 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8614 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8615 exists.
8616
8617 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8618 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8619 unobvious parameters.
8620
8621 Example :
8622 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8623 backend public_www
8624 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8625 stats enable
8626 stats hide-version
8627 stats scope .
8628 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008629 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008630 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8631 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8632
8633 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8634 backend private_monitoring
8635 stats enable
8636 stats uri /admin?stats
8637 stats refresh 5s
8638
8639 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8640
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008641
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008642stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008643 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008645 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008646
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008647 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008648 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8649
8650 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8651 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8652
8653 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8654 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008655 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008656
8657 Example :
8658 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8659 backend private_monitoring
8660 stats enable
8661 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8662 stats uri /admin?stats
8663 stats refresh 5s
8664
8665 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8666 global section.
8667
8668
8669stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008670 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8672 yes | yes | yes | yes
8673 Arguments : none
8674
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008675 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008676 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8677 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8678 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8679 - IP (socket, server)
8680 - cookie (backend, server)
8681
8682 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8683 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008684 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008685
8686 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8687
8688
8689stats show-node [ <name> ]
8690 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008692 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008693 Arguments:
8694 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8695 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8696
8697 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8698 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008699 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008700
8701 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8702 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8703 unobvious parameters.
8704
8705 Example:
8706 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8707 backend private_monitoring
8708 stats enable
8709 stats show-node Europe-1
8710 stats uri /admin?stats
8711 stats refresh 5s
8712
8713 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8714 section.
8715
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008716
8717stats uri <prefix>
8718 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008720 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008721 Arguments :
8722 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8723 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8724 query string.
8725
8726 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8727 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8728 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8729 possible to reach it in the application.
8730
8731 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008732 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008733 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8734 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8735 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8736 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8737
8738 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8739 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8740 an address or a port to statistics only.
8741
8742 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8743 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8744 unobvious parameters.
8745
8746 Example :
8747 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8748 backend public_www
8749 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8750 stats enable
8751 stats hide-version
8752 stats scope .
8753 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008754 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008755 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8756 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8757
8758 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8759 backend private_monitoring
8760 stats enable
8761 stats uri /admin?stats
8762 stats refresh 5s
8763
8764 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8765
8766
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008767stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8768 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008770 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008771
8772 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008773 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008774 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008775 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008776 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8777
8778 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8779 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8780 the "stick-table" statement.
8781
8782 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8783 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8784 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8785 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8786 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8787
8788 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8789 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8790 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8791 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8792 transformation rules.
8793
8794 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8795 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8796 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8797 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8798 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8799 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8800 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8801
8802 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8803 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8804 ACL based conditions.
8805
8806 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8807 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8808 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8809 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8810
8811 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8812 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8813 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8814 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8815
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008816 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8817 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008818 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008819
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008820 Example :
8821 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8822 # last 30 minutes
8823 backend pop
8824 mode tcp
8825 balance roundrobin
8826 stick store-request src
8827 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8828 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8829 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8830
8831 backend smtp
8832 mode tcp
8833 balance roundrobin
8834 stick match src table pop
8835 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8836 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8837
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008838 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008839 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008840
8841
8842stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8843 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8845 no | no | yes | yes
8846
8847 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8848 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8849 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8850 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8851
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008852 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8853 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008854 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008855
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008856 Examples :
8857 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008858 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008859
8860 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8861 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8862 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8863
8864
8865 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8866 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8867 backend http
8868 mode http
8869 balance roundrobin
8870 stick on src table https
8871 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8872 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8873 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8874
8875 backend https
8876 mode tcp
8877 balance roundrobin
8878 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8879 stick on src
8880 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8881 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8882
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008883 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008884
8885
8886stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8887 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8889 no | no | yes | yes
8890
8891 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008892 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008893 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008894 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008895 server is selected.
8896
8897 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8898 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8899 the "stick-table" statement.
8900
8901 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8902 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8903 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8904 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8905 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8906 address.
8907
8908 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8909 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8910 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8911 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8912 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8913 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8914 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8915 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8916 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8917 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8918
8919 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8920 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8921 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8922 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8923 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8924 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8925 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8926
8927 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8928 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8929 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8930 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8931
8932 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8933 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8934 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8935 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8936 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8937 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008938 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8939 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8940 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8941 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8942 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8943 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008944
8945 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8946 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8947 the request.
8948
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008949 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8950 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008951 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008952
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008953 Example :
8954 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8955 # last 30 minutes
8956 backend pop
8957 mode tcp
8958 balance roundrobin
8959 stick store-request src
8960 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8961 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8962 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8963
8964 backend smtp
8965 mode tcp
8966 balance roundrobin
8967 stick match src table pop
8968 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8969 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8970
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008971 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008972 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008973
8974
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008975stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008976 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8977 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008978 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008980 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008981
8982 Arguments :
8983 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8984 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8985 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8986 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8987
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008988 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8989 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8990 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8991 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8992
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008993 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8994 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8995 instance.
8996
8997 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8998 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8999 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9000 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9001 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9002 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009003 to 32 characters.
9004
9005 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9006 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9007 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009008 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009009 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9010 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009011
9012 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009013 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9014 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009015 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9016 increase.
9017
9018 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009019 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9020 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9021 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009022
9023 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9024 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9025 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9026 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009027 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009028 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9029 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9030 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9031 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9032 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9033 parameter (see below).
9034
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009035 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9036 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9037 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9038 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9039 soft restart.
9040
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009041 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9042 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009043
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009044 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9045 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9046 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9047 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009048 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009049 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009050 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9051 if not expiration delay is specified.
9052
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009053 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9054 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9055 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9056 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009057 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9058 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9059 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9060 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9061 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9062 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9063 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9064 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9065 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9066 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9067 types and their arguments.
9068
9069 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9070 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9071 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9072 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9073
9074 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9075 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9076 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009077 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009078
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009079 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9080 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9081 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009082 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009083 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009084 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009085
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009086 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9087 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9088 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9089 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9090
9091 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9092 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9093 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9094 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9095 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9096 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9097
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009098 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9099 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9100 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9101 they were received.
9102
9103 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9104 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9105 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9106 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9107 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9108
9109 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9110 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9111 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9112 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9113 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9114
9115 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9116 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9117 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9118
9119 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9120 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9121 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9122 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9123 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9124
9125 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9126 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9127 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9128 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9129 the client side.
9130
9131 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9132 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9133 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9134 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9135 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9136 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9137 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9138
9139 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9140 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9141 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9142 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9143 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9144 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009145 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009146
9147 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9148 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9149 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9150 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9151 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9152 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9153
9154 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009155 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009156 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9157 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9158
9159 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9160 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9161 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9162 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9163 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9164 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9165 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9166 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9167 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9168 recommended for better fairness.
9169
9170 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009171 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009172 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9173 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9174
9175 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9176 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9177 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9178 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9179 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9180 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9181 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9182 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9183 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9184 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009185
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009186 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9187 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009188 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9189 reference it.
9190
9191 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9192 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009193 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9194 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9195 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009196
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009197 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9198 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9199 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9200 something that can be ignored.
9201
9202 Example:
9203 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9204 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9205 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9206 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9207
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009208 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009209 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009210
9211
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009212stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009213 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9215 no | no | yes | yes
9216
9217 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009218 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009219 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009220 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009221 server is selected.
9222
9223 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9224 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9225 the "stick-table" statement.
9226
9227 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9228 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9229 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9230 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9231
9232 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9233 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9234 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9235 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9236 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9237 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009238 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009239 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9240 rules.
9241
9242 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9243 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9244 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9245 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9246 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9247 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9248 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9249
9250 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9251 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9252 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9253 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9254
9255 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9256 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9257 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9258 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9259 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9260 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009261 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9262 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9263 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9264 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9265 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9266 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9267 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9268 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9269 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009270
9271 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9272
9273 Example :
9274 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9275 backend https
9276 mode tcp
9277 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009278 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009279 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009280
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009281 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9282 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9283
9284 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9285 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9286 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9287
9288 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9289 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009290
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009291 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9292 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9293 # at offset 44.
9294
9295 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9296 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9297
9298 # Learn on response if server hello.
9299 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009300
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009301 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9302 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9303
9304 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9305 extraction.
9306
9307
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009308tcp-check connect [params*]
9309 Opens a new connection
9310 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9311 no | no | yes | yes
9312
9313 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9314 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9315 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9316
9317 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9318 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9319 of the sequence.
9320
9321 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9322 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9323 do.
9324
9325 Parameters :
9326 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9327 use the TCP connection.
9328
9329 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9330 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9331 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9332
9333 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9334
9335 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9336
9337 Examples:
9338 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9339 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9340 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9341 option tcp-check
9342 tcp-check connect
9343 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9344 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9345 tcp-check send \r\n
9346 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9347 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9348 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9349 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9350 tcp-check send \r\n
9351 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9352 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9353
9354 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9355 option tcp-check
9356 tcp-check connect port 110
9357 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9358 tcp-check connect port 143
9359 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9360 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9361
9362 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9363
9364
9365tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009366 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009367 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9368 no | no | yes | yes
9369
9370 Arguments :
9371 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9372 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9373 binary.
9374 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9375 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9376 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9377
9378 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9379 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9380 with the usual backslash ('\').
9381 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009382 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009383 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9384 used upper or lower case.
9385
9386
9387 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9388
9389 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9390 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9391 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9392 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9393 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9394 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9395 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9396 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9397
9398 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9399 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9400 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9401 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9402 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9403 expression.
9404
9405 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9406 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9407 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9408 this exact hexadecimal string.
9409 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9410
9411 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9412 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9413 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9414 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9415 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9416 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9417 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9418 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9419 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9420 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9421 the null character.
9422
9423 Examples :
9424 # perform a POP check
9425 option tcp-check
9426 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9427
9428 # perform an IMAP check
9429 option tcp-check
9430 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9431
9432 # look for the redis master server
9433 option tcp-check
9434 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009435 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009436 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9437 tcp-check expect string role:master
9438 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9439 tcp-check expect string +OK
9440
9441
9442 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9443 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9444
9445
9446tcp-check send <data>
9447 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9448 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9449 no | no | yes | yes
9450
9451 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9452 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9453
9454 Examples :
9455 # look for the redis master server
9456 option tcp-check
9457 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9458 tcp-check expect string role:master
9459
9460 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9461 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9462
9463
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009464tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9465 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009466 tcp health check
9467 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9468 no | no | yes | yes
9469
9470 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9471 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009472 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009473 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9474 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9475 hexadecimal string.
9476 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9477
9478 Examples :
9479 # redis check in binary
9480 option tcp-check
9481 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9482 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9483
9484
9485 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9486 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9487
9488
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009489tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9490 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9492 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009493 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009494 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9495 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009496
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009497 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009498
9499 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9500 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009501 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9502 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9503 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9504 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9505 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9506 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009507
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009508 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9509 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9510 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9511 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009512
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009513 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009514 - accept :
9515 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9516 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9517 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009518
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009519 - reject :
9520 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9521 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9522 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9523 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9524 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9525 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9526 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9527 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9528 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9529 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9530 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009531 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009532
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009533 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9534 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9535 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9536 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9537 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9538 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9539 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9540 hosts.
9541
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009542 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9543 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9544 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9545 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9546 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9547 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9548 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9549 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9550
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009551 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9552 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9553 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9554 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9555 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9556 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9557 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9558 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9559 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009560 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9561 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009562
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009563 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009564 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009565 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9566 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9567 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9568 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9569 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9570 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9571 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9572 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9573 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9574 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9575 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9576 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009577
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009578 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009579 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009580 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009581 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009582 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9583 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9584 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009585
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009586 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9587 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9588 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9589 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009590
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009591 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9592 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9593 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9594 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9595 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009596 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9597 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9598 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9599 layer7 information is extracted.
9600
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009601 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9602 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9603 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9604 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9605 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009606
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009607 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9608 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9609 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9610 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9611
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009612 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9613 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9614 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9615 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9616
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009617 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9618 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9619 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9620 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9621 continues.
9622
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009623 - set-src <expr> :
9624 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9625 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9626 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009627 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009628
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009629 Arguments:
9630 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9631 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009632
9633 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009634 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9635
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009636 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9637 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009638
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009639 - set-src-port <expr> :
9640 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9641 expression.
9642
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009643 Arguments:
9644 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9645 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009646
9647 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009648 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9649
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009650 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9651 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9652 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009653
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009654 - set-dst <expr> :
9655 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9656 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9657 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9658 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9659 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9660
9661 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9662 followed by some converters.
9663
9664 Example:
9665
9666 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9667 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9668
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009669 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9670 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9671
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009672 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9673 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9674 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9675 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9676
9677
9678 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9679 followed by some converters.
9680
9681 Example:
9682
9683 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9684
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009685 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9686 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9687 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9688
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009689 - "silent-drop" :
9690 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009691 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009692 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9693 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9694 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9695 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9696 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009697 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9698 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009699 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9700 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009701 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009702 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9703 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9704 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9705 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9706
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009707 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9708 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9709 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009710
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009711 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9712 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9713 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009714
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009715 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009716 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009717 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009718
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009719 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9720 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9721 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009722
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009723 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009724 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9725 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009726
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009727 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9728
9729 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9730
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009731 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9732
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009733 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009734
9735
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009736tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9737 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009739 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009740 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009741 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9742 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009743
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009744 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009745
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009746 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009747 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9748 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9749 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9750 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009751
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009752 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9753 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9754 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9755 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009756 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9757 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9758 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9759 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9760 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9761 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009762 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009763 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009764
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009765 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9766 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9767 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9768 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009769
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009770 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009771 - accept : the request is accepted
9772 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9773 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009774 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009775 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009776 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009777 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009778 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009779 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009780 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009781 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009782 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009783
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009784 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9785 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009786
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009787 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9788 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9789 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9790 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9791 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9792 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009794 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009795 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9796 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009797
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009798 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009799 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9800 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9801 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9802 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009803 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9804 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9805 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009806
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009807 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009808 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9809 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9810 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009811
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009812 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009813 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9814 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009815
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009816 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9817 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009818 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009819 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9820 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009821 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009822 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009823 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009824 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9825 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009826 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009827 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9828 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009829
9830 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9831 followed by some converters.
9832
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009833 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9834 <var-name>.
9835
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009836 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9837 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9838 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9839 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9840 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9841
9842 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9843 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9844 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9845 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9846 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9847 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9848 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9849 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9850 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9851 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9852 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9853
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009854 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9855 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9856 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9857 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9858 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9859
9860 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9861
9862 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9863
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009864 Example:
9865
9866 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009867 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009868
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009869 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009870 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9871 # and reject everything else.
9872 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9873 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009874 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009875 tcp-request content reject
9876
9877 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009878 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9879 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9880 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009881 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009882
9883 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9884 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9885 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009886 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009887 tcp-request content reject
9888
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009889 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009890 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009891 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009892 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009893 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9894 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009895
9896 Example:
9897 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9898 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009899 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009900
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009901 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009902 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009903
9904 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009905 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009906 # protecting all our sites
9907 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009908 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9909 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009910 ...
9911 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9912
9913 backend http_dynamic
9914 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009915 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009916 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009917 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009918 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009919 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009920 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009922 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009923
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009924 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9925 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009926
9927
9928tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9929 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009931 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009932 Arguments :
9933 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9934 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9935 as explained at the top of this document.
9936
9937 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9938 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9939 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9940 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9941 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9942
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009943 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9944 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9945 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9946 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9947
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009948 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9949 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009950 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009951 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009952 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9953 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9954 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9955 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009956
9957 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9958 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9959 it pass through unaffected.
9960
9961 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9962 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9963 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009964 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009965 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9966 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009967 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9968 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9969 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009970
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009971 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009972 "timeout client".
9973
9974
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009975tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9976 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9978 no | no | yes | yes
9979 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009980 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9981 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009982
9983 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9984
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009985 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009986 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9987 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009988 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9989 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009990
9991 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9992
9993 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9994 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9995 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9996 inserted.
9997
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009998 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009999 - accept :
10000 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10001 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10002 the rules evaluation.
10003
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010004 - close :
10005 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10006 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10007 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10008 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10009 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10010 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010011 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010012 protocols.
10013
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010014 - reject :
10015 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10016 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010017 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010018
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010019 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10020 Sets a variable.
10021
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010022 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10023 Unsets a variable.
10024
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010025 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10026 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10027 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10028 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10029
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010030 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10031 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10032 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10033 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10034
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010035 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10036 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10037 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10038 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10039 continues.
10040
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010041 - "silent-drop" :
10042 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010043 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010044 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10045 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10046 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10047 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10048 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010049 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10050 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010051 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10052 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010053 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010054 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10055 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10056 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10057 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10058
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010059 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10060 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10061
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010062 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10063 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10064 for changing the default action to a reject.
10065
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010066 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10067 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10068 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10069 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010070 period.
10071
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010072 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10073 declared inline.
10074
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010075 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10076 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010077 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010078 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10079 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010080 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010081 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010082 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010083 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10084 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010085 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010086 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10087 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010088
10089 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10090 followed by some converters.
10091
10092 Example:
10093
10094 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10095
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010096 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10097 <var-name>.
10098
10099 Example:
10100
10101 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10102
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010103 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10104 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10105 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10106 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10107 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10108
10109 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10110
10111 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10112
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010113 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10114
10115 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10116
10117
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010118tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10119 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10121 no | yes | yes | no
10122 Arguments :
10123 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10124 below.
10125
10126 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10127
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010128 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010129 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10130 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10131 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10132 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10133 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10134 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10135 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010136 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010137 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10138 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10139 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10140 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10141 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10142 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10143 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10144 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10145 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10146 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10147 instead.
10148
10149 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10150 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10151 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10152 rules which may be inserted.
10153
10154 Several types of actions are supported :
10155 - accept : the request is accepted
10156 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10157 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10158 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010159 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010160 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10161 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010162 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010163 - silent-drop
10164
10165 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10166 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10167 sections for a complete description.
10168
10169 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10170 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10171 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10172
10173 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10174 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10175 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10176 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10177 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10178
10179 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10180 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10181
10182 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10183 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10184 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10185
10186 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10187 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10188 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10189
10190 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10191 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10192 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10193
10194 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10195 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10196 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10197
10198 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10199
10200 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10201
10202
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010203tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10204 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10206 no | no | yes | yes
10207 Arguments :
10208 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10209 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10210 as explained at the top of this document.
10211
10212 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10213
10214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010215timeout check <timeout>
10216 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10217 established.
10218
10219 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10220 yes | no | yes | yes
10221 Arguments:
10222 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10223 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10224 as explained at the top of this document.
10225
10226 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10227 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010228 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010229 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010230 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10231 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10232 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010233
10234 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10235 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10236
10237 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10238 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010239 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010240
10241 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10242 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10243 forget about it.
10244
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010245 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10246 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010247
10248
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010249timeout client <timeout>
10250timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10251 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10253 yes | yes | yes | no
10254 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010255 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010256 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10257 as explained at the top of this document.
10258
10259 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10260 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10261 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010262 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10263 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10264 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10265 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010266 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10267 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10268 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010269 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010270 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010271 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10272 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010273 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10274 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010275
10276 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10277 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10278 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10279 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10280 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10281 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10282
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010283 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010284
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010285 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10286 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10287 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10288
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010289 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10290 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010291
10292
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010293timeout client-fin <timeout>
10294 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10296 yes | yes | yes | no
10297 Arguments :
10298 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10299 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10300 as explained at the top of this document.
10301
10302 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10303 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10304 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10305 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10306 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10307 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10308 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010309 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10310 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10311 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010312
10313 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10314 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10315 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10316
10317 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10318
10319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010320timeout connect <timeout>
10321timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10322 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10324 yes | no | yes | yes
10325 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10328 as explained at the top of this document.
10329
10330 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010331 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010332 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010333 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010334 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10335 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010336
10337 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10338 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10339 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10340 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10341 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10342 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10343
10344 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10345 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10346 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10347
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010348 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10349 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010350
10351
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010352timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10353 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10355 yes | yes | yes | yes
10356 Arguments :
10357 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10358 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10359 as explained at the top of this document.
10360
10361 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10362 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10363 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10364 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10365 once the request has started to present itself.
10366
10367 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10368 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10369 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10370 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10371 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10372
10373 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10374 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10375 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10376 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10377
10378 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10379 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010380 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010381 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10382 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010383 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010384
10385 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10386 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10387 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10388 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10389
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010390 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10391 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010392 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10393
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010394 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10395
10396
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010397timeout http-request <timeout>
10398 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010400 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010401 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010402 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010403 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10404 as explained at the top of this document.
10405
10406 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10407 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10408 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10409 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10410 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10411 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10412 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010413 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10414 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10415 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10416 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010417 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010418 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10419 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010420
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010421 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10422 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10423 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10424 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10425 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010426 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010427
10428 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10429 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010430 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010431 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10432 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10433
10434 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010435 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10436 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10437 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010438
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010439 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010440 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010441
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010442
10443timeout queue <timeout>
10444 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10446 yes | no | yes | yes
10447 Arguments :
10448 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10449 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10450 as explained at the top of this document.
10451
10452 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10453 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10454 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10455 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10456 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10457
10458 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10459 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10460 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10461 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10462
10463 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10464
10465
10466timeout server <timeout>
10467timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10468 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10470 yes | no | yes | yes
10471 Arguments :
10472 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10473 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10474 as explained at the top of this document.
10475
10476 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10477 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10478 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10479 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10480 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10481 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10482 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10483
10484 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10485 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10486 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10487 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10488 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010489 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010490 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010491 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10492 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010493 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10494 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010495
10496 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10497 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10498 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10499 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10500 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10501 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10502
10503 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10504 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10505 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10506
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010507 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010508
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010509
10510timeout server-fin <timeout>
10511 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10513 yes | no | yes | yes
10514 Arguments :
10515 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10516 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10517 as explained at the top of this document.
10518
10519 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10520 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10521 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10522 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10523 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10524 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10525 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10526 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10527 situations, it should not be needed.
10528
10529 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10530 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10531 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10532
10533 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10534
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010535
10536timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010537 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10539 yes | yes | yes | yes
10540 Arguments :
10541 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10542 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10543 as explained at the top of this document.
10544
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010545 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10546 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10547 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10548 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010549
10550 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10551 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10552 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10553 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010554 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010555
10556 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10557
10558
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010559timeout tunnel <timeout>
10560 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10562 yes | no | yes | yes
10563 Arguments :
10564 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10565 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10566 as explained at the top of this document.
10567
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010568 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010569 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10570 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10571 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010572 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10573 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010574 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10575 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10576 specified.
10577
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010578 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10579 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10580 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10581 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10582 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10583 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10584 state.
10585
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010586 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10587 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10588 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10589 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010590 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010591
10592 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10593 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10594 forget about it.
10595
10596 Example :
10597 defaults http
10598 option http-server-close
10599 timeout connect 5s
10600 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010601 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010602 timeout server 30s
10603 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10604
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010605 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010606
10607
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010608transparent (deprecated)
10609 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010611 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010612 Arguments : none
10613
10614 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10615 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10616 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10617 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10618 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10619 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10620 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10621 appropriate server.
10622
10623 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10624
10625 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10626 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10627
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010628 See also: "option transparent"
10629
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010630unique-id-format <string>
10631 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10633 yes | yes | yes | no
10634 Arguments :
10635 <string> is a log-format string.
10636
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010637 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10638 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10639 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10640 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010641
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010642 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10643 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10644 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10645 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10646 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10647 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10648 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10649 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010650
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010651 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10652 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010653
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010654 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010655
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010656 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010657
10658 will generate:
10659
10660 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10661
10662 See also: "unique-id-header"
10663
10664unique-id-header <name>
10665 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10667 yes | yes | yes | no
10668 Arguments :
10669 <name> is the name of the header.
10670
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010671 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10672 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010673
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010674 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010675
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010676 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010677 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10678
10679 will generate:
10680
10681 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10682
10683 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010684
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010685use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010686 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10688 no | yes | yes | no
10689 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010690 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10691 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010692
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010693 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10694 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010695
10696 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10697 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10698 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010699 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010700 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010701 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10702 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010703
10704 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10705 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10706 assign the backend.
10707
10708 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10709 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10710 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10711 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10712 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10713 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10714
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010715 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010716 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010717 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10718 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10719 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10720
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010721 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10722 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10723 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10724 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10725 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10726 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10727 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10728 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10729 cannot be forced from the request.
10730
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010731 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010732 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10733 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10734
10735 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10736 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010737
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010738
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010739use-server <server> if <condition>
10740use-server <server> unless <condition>
10741 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10743 no | no | yes | yes
10744 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010745 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010746
10747 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10748
10749 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10750 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10751 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10752
10753 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10754 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10755 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10756 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10757 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10758 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10759 matches will assign the server.
10760
10761 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10762 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10763 with the next rules until one matches.
10764
10765 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10766 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10767 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10768 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10769
10770 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10771 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10772 stripped.
10773
10774 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10775 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10776 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10777 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10778
10779 Example :
10780 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10781 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10782 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10783 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10784 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10785 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010786 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010787 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10788 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10789
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010790 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010791
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010792
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107935. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010794--------------------------
10795
10796The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10797depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10798settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10799written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10800described in this section.
10801
10802
108035.1. Bind options
10804-----------------
10805
10806The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10807as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10808no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10809parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10810while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10811provided immediately after the setting name.
10812
10813The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10814
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010815accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10816 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10817 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10818 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10819 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10820 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10821 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10822 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10823 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10824 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010825 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10826 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10827 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010828
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010829accept-proxy
10830 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010831 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10832 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010833 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10834 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10835 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10836 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010837 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010838 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10839 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010840 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10841 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010842
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010843allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010844 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010845 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10846 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10847 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10848 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010849
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010850alpn <protocols>
10851 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10852 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10853 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10854 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10855 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010856 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10857 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10858 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10859 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10860 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10861 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10862 preference, like below :
10863
10864 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010865
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010866backlog <backlog>
10867 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10868 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10869
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010870curves <curves>
10871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10872 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10873 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10874 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10875 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10876 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10877
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010878ecdhe <named curve>
10879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010880 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10881 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010882
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010883ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010884 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10885 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10886 client's certificate.
10887
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010888ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10890 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10891 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10892 error is ignored.
10893
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010894ca-sign-file <cafile>
10895 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10896 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10897 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10898 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10899 'generate-certificates' for details.
10900
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010901ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010902 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10903 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10904 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10905 'generate-certificates' for details.
10906
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010907ciphers <ciphers>
10908 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10909 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010910 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010911 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010912 information and recommendations see e.g.
10913 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10914 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10915 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10916
10917ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10918 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10919 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10920 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10921 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010922 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10923 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010924
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010925crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010926 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10927 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10928 to verify client's certificate.
10929
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010930crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10932 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10933 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10934 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10935 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10936 file.
10937
10938 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10939 are loaded.
10940
10941 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010942 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010943 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10944 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10945 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10946 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010947 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10948 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010949 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010950
10951 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10952 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10953 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10954 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010955 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10956 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010957
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010958 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010959
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010960 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010961 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010962 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10963 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010964 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10965 clients).
10966
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010967 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10968 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10969 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10970 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10971 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10972 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10973 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10974 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10975 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10976 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10977 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10978 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10979 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10980
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010981 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10982 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10983 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10984 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10985 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10986
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010987 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10988 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10989 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10990 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010991
10992 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10993 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10994 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10995 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10996 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10997 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10998 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10999 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11000 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11001
11002 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11003
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011004 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011005 a cert bundle.
11006
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011007 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011008 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11009 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11010 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11011 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11012 provide multi-cert support.
11013
11014 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11015
11016 Filename | CN | SAN
11017 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11018 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011019 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011020 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11021 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11022
11023 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11024 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11025 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11026 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011027 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11028 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11029 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011030
11031 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11032 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11033
11034 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11035 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11036 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11037
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011038crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011039 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011040 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011041 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011042 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011043
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011044crt-list <file>
11045 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011046 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11047 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011048
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011049 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11050
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011051 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11052 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011053 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011054 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011055
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011056 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11057 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11058 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11059 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11060 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11061 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11062 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11063 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011064
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011065 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011066 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011067 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11068 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11069 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011070
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011071 crt-list file example:
11072 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011073 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011074 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011075 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011076
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011077defer-accept
11078 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11079 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11080 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011081 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011082 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11083 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11084 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11085 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11086 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11087 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11088 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11089
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011090expose-fd listeners
11091 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11092 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011093 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11094 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011095 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011096
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011097force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011098 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011099 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011100 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011101 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011102
11103force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011104 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011105 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011106 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011107
11108force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011109 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011110 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011111 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011112
11113force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011114 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011115 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011116 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011117
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011118force-tlsv13
11119 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11120 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011121 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011122
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011123generate-certificates
11124 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11125 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11126 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11127 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11128 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11129 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11130 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11131 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11132 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11133 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11134 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11135
11136 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11137 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011138 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011139 certificate is used many times.
11140
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011141gid <gid>
11142 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11143 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11144 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11145 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11146 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11147
11148group <group>
11149 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11150 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11151 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11152 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11153 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11154
11155id <id>
11156 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11157 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11158 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11159 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11160
11161interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011162 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11163 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11164 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11165 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11166 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11167 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011168 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11169 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11170 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11171 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11172 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11173 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011174
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011175level <level>
11176 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11177 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11178 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011179 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011180 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11181 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11182 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011183 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011184 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011185 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011186 all counters).
11187
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011188severity-output <format>
11189 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11190 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11191 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11192 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11193 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11194 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11195 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11196 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11197 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11198 rfc5424 convention.
11199
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011200maxconn <maxconn>
11201 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11202 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11203 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11204 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11205 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11206 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11207 eat all memory.
11208
11209mode <mode>
11210 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11211 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11212 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11213 UNIX sockets.
11214
11215mss <maxseg>
11216 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11217 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11218 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11219 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11220 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11221 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11222 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11223 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11224 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11225 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11226 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11227
11228name <name>
11229 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11230 page.
11231
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011232namespace <name>
11233 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11234 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11235 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11236 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11237
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011238nice <nice>
11239 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11240 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11241 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11242 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11243 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11244 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11245 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11246 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11247 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11248 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11249 one for an RDP socket.
11250
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011251no-ca-names
11252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11253 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11254
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011255no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011257 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011258 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011259 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011260 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11261 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011262
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011263no-tls-tickets
11264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11265 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11266 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011267 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11268 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011269
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011270no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011272 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011273 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011274 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011275 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11276 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011277
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011278no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011280 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011281 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011282 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011283 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11284 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011285
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011286no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011287 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011288 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011289 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011290 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011291 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11292 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011293
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011294no-tlsv13
11295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11296 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11297 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11298 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011299 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11300 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011301
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011302npn <protocols>
11303 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11304 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11305 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11306 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011307 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011308 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11309 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11310 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11311 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11312 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011313
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011314prefer-client-ciphers
11315 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11316 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11317 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011318 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11319 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11320 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011321
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011322process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11323 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11324 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011325 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011326 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11327 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11328 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11329 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011330 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011331 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11332 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11333 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11334
11335 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11336
11337 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11338 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11339 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11340 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11341 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11342 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11343 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11344 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011345
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011346proto <name>
11347 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11348 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11349 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11350 in haproxy -vv.
11351 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11352 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011353 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011354 h2" on the bind line.
11355
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011356ssl
11357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011358 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011359 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11360 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011361 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11362 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011363
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011364ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11365 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11366 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11367 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11368
11369ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11370 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11371 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11372 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11373
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011374strict-sni
11375 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11376 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11377 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11378 See the "crt" option for more information.
11379
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011380tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011381 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011382 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11383 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011384 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011385 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11386 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11387 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11388 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11389 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11390 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11391 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11392
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011393tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011394 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011395 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11396 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11397 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11398 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11399 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11400 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11401 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011402 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11403 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11404 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011405
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011406tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11407 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011408 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11409 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11410 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11411 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11412 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11413 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11414 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11415 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11416 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11417 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011418 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11419 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11420
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011421transparent
11422 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11423 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11424 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11425 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11426 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11427 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11428 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11429 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11430 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11431 so check for support with your vendor.
11432
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011433v4v6
11434 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11435 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11436 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11437 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011438 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011439
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011440v6only
11441 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11442 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11443 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011444 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11445 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011446
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011447uid <uid>
11448 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11449 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11450 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11451 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11452 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11453
11454user <user>
11455 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11456 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11457 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11458 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11459 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11460
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011461verify [none|optional|required]
11462 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11463 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11464 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11465 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11466 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011467 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11468 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11469 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11470 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011471
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114725.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011473------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011475The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11476which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11477arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11478settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11479after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11480Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11481address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011483 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011484 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011485
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011486Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11487keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011489The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011490
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011491addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011492 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011493 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11494 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11495 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11496 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11497 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011498
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011499agent-check
11500 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011501 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011502 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11503 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11504 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011505
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011506 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011507 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011508 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11509 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11510 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011511
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011512 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11513 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11514 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11515 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11516 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011517
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011518 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011519 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011520
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011521 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11522 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11523 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011524
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011525 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11526 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11527 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011528
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011529 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11530 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11531 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11532 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11533 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011534 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011535 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011536
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011537 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11538 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011539
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011540 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11541 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11542 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11543 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11544 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11545 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11546 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11547 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11548 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011549
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011550 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11551 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011552 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11553 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11554 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011555 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011556
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011557 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011558 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011559
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011560agent-send <string>
11561 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11562 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11563 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11564 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11565 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11566
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011567agent-inter <delay>
11568 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11569 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11570
11571 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11572 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11573 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11574 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11575 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11576 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11577 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11578 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11579 of backends use the same servers.
11580
11581 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11582
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011583agent-addr <addr>
11584 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11585
11586 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11587 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11588 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11589 hostname, it will be resolved.
11590
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011591agent-port <port>
11592 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11593
11594 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11595
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011596alpn <protocols>
11597 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11598 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11599 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11600 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11601 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11602 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11603 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11604 now obsolete NPN extension.
11605 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11606 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11607
11608 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011610backup
11611 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11612 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11613 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11614 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011615 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11616 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011617
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011618ca-file <cafile>
11619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11620 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11621 server's certificate.
11622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011623check
11624 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011625 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11626 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11627 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11628 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11629 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11630 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11631 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011632 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11633 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011634 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11635 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011636
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011637check-send-proxy
11638 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11639 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11640 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11641 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11642 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11643 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11644 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11645
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011646check-alpn <protocols>
11647 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11648 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11649 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11650
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011651check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011652 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011653 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11654 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011655
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011656check-ssl
11657 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11658 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11659 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11660 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011661 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011662 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11663 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011664 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011665 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11666 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011667
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011668ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011669 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11670 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11671 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011672 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11673 information and recommendations see e.g.
11674 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11675 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11676 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011677
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011678ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11679 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11680 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11681 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11682 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011683 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11684 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11685 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011686
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011687cookie <value>
11688 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11689 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11690 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11691 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11692 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11693 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11694 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11695
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011696crl-file <crlfile>
11697 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11698 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11699 to verify server's certificate.
11700
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011701crt <cert>
11702 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11703 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11704 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11705 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11706 certificate request.
11707
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011708disabled
11709 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11710 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11711 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11712 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11713 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011714 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011715
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011716enabled
11717 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11718 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11719 default value.
11720 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11721 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011722
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011723error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011724 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11725 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11726 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011728 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011730fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011731 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11732 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11733 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11734
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011735force-sslv3
11736 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11737 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011738 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011739 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011740
11741force-tlsv10
11742 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011743 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011744 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011745
11746force-tlsv11
11747 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011748 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011749 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011750
11751force-tlsv12
11752 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011753 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011754 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011755
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011756force-tlsv13
11757 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11758 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011759 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011761id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011762 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11763 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11764 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011765
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011766init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11767 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11768 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011769 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011770 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11771 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11772 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11773 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11774 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11775 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11776 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11777 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11778 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011779 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011780 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11781 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11782 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11783 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11784 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11785 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011786 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011787
11788 Example:
11789 defaults
11790 # never fail on address resolution
11791 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11792
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011793inter <delay>
11794fastinter <delay>
11795downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011796 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11797 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11798 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11799 between checks depending on the server state :
11800
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011801 Server state | Interval used
11802 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11803 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11804 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11805 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11806 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11807 or yet unchecked. |
11808 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11809 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11810 | "inter" otherwise.
11811 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011813 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11814 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11815 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11816 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011817 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11818 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11819 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11820 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11821 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011823maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011824 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11825 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11826 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11827 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11828 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11829 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11830 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11831 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011833maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011834 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11835 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11836 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11837 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11838 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11839 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11840 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11841
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011842max-reuse <count>
11843 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11844 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11845 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11846 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11847 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11848 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11849 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11850 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011852minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011853 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11854 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11855 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11856 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11857 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11858 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011859 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011860 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011861
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011862namespace <name>
11863 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11864 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11865 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11866 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11867
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011868no-agent-check
11869 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11870 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11871 default value.
11872 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11873 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11874
11875no-backup
11876 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11877 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11878 default value.
11879 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11880 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11881
11882no-check
11883 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11884 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11885 default value.
11886 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11887 "default-server" "check" setting.
11888
11889no-check-ssl
11890 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11891 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11892 default value.
11893 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11894 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11895
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011896no-send-proxy
11897 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11898 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11899 default value.
11900 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11901 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11902
11903no-send-proxy-v2
11904 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11905 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11906 default value.
11907 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11908 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11909
11910no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11911 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11912 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11913 default value.
11914 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11915 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11916
11917no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11918 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11919 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11920 default value.
11921 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11922 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11923
11924no-ssl
11925 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11926 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11927 default value.
11928 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11929 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11930
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011931no-ssl-reuse
11932 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11933 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11934 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11935 and for paranoid users.
11936
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011937no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011938 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11939 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011940 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011941
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011942 Supported in default-server: No
11943
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011944no-tls-tickets
11945 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11946 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11947 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011948 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11949 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011950 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011951
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011952no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011953 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011954 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11955 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011956 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11957 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011958 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011959
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011960 Supported in default-server: No
11961
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011962no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011963 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011964 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11965 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011966 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11967 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011968 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011969
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011970 Supported in default-server: No
11971
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011972no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011973 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011974 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11975 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011976 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11977 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011978 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011979
11980 Supported in default-server: No
11981
11982no-tlsv13
11983 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11984 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11985 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11986 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11987 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011988 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011989
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011990 Supported in default-server: No
11991
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011992no-verifyhost
11993 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11994 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11995 default value.
11996 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11997 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011998
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011999non-stick
12000 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12001 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12002 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12003
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012004npn <protocols>
12005 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12006 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12007 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12008 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12009 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12010 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12011 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12012
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012013observe <mode>
12014 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12015 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12016 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12017 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12018 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12019 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012020 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012021
12022 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012024on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012025 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12026 Currently, four modes are available:
12027 - fastinter: force fastinter
12028 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12029 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12030 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12031 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12032
12033 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12034
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012035on-marked-down <action>
12036 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12037 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012038 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12039 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12040 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12041 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12042 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12043 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12044 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12045 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012046
12047 Actions are disabled by default
12048
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012049on-marked-up <action>
12050 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12051 Currently one action is available:
12052 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12053 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12054 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12055 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012056 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12057 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012058 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12059 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12060
12061 Actions are disabled by default
12062
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012063pool-max-conn <max>
12064 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12065 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12066 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12067 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12068 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12069 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12070
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012071pool-purge-delay <delay>
12072 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
12073 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means it's never purged. The default is
12074 1s.
12075
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012076port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012077 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12078 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12079 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12080 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12081 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12082 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12083
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012084proto <name>
12085
12086 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12087 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12088 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12089 reported in haproxy -vv.
12090 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12091 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012093redir <prefix>
12094 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12095 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12096 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12097 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12098 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12099 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12100 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12101 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012102 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012103 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012104 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12105 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12106 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12107 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12108
12109 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012111rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012112 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12113 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12114 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12115
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012116resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12117 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12118 server.
12119
12120 Available options:
12121
12122 * allow-dup-ip
12123 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12124 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12125 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12126 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12127 For such case, simply enable this option.
12128 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12129
12130 * prevent-dup-ip
12131 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12132 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12133 same fqdn.
12134 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12135
12136 Example:
12137 backend b_myapp
12138 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12139 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12140 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12141
12142 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12143 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12144 it
12145 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12146 different address
12147
12148 Default value: not set
12149
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012150resolve-prefer <family>
12151 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12152 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12153 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12154 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12155
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012156 Default value: ipv6
12157
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012158 Example:
12159
12160 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012161
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012162resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12163 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12164 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012165 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012166 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12167 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012168 configured network, another address is selected.
12169
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012170 Example:
12171
12172 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012173
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012174resolvers <id>
12175 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12176 hostname.
12177
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012178 Example:
12179
12180 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012181
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012182 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012183
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012184send-proxy
12185 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12186 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12187 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12188 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012189 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12190 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12191 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12192 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12193 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12194 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12195 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12196 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12197 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12198 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012199 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12200 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012201
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012202send-proxy-v2
12203 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12204 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12205 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12206 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012207 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12208 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12209 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12210 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012211
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012212proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12213 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12214 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012215 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12216 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012217 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12218 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012219 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012220
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012221send-proxy-v2-ssl
12222 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12223 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12224 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12225 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12226 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12227 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12228 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012229 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12230 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012231
12232send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12233 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12234 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12235 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12236 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12237 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12238 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12239 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12240 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012241 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12242 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012243
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012244slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012245 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12246 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12247 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12248 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12249 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12250 parameters :
12251
12252 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12253 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12254
12255 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12256 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12257 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12258 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12259
12260 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12261 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12262 seen as failed.
12263
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012264sni <expression>
12265 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12266 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12267 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12268 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012269 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12270 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012271 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012272 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12273 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012274
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012275source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012276source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012277source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012278 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12279 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12280 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12281 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12282
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012283 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12284 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12285 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12286 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12287 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12288 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12289 server.
12290
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012291 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12292 specifying the source address without port(s).
12293
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012294ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012295 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12296 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12297 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12298 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12299 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12300 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012301 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12302 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012303
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012304ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12305 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12306 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12307 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12308
12309ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12310 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12311 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12312 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12313
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012314ssl-reuse
12315 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12316 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12317 default value.
12318 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12319 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12320
12321stick
12322 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12323 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12324 default value.
12325 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12326 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012327
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012328tcp-ut <delay>
12329 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12330 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12331 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012332 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012333 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12334 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12335 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12336 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12337 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12338 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12339 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12340 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12341 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012343track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012344 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12345 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12346 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12347 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012348 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12349
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012350tls-tickets
12351 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12352 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12353 default value.
12354 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12355 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012356
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012357verify [none|required]
12358 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012359 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012360 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12361 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012362 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012363 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12364 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12365 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12366 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12367 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12368 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12369 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12370 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012371
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012372verifyhost <hostname>
12373 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012374 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12375 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12376 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12377 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12378 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12379 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12380 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12381 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012383weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012384 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12385 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12386 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012387 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12388 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12389 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12390 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12391 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12392 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012393
12394
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123955.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12396-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012397
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012398HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12399using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12400configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012401This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12402can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12403workload.
12404This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12405resolution at run time.
12406Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12407carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12408
12409
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124105.3.1. Global overview
12411----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012412
12413As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12414different steps of the process life:
12415
12416 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12417 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12418 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12419
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012420 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12421 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012422
12423A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12424 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12425 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12426 resolution to know this new IP.
12427
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012428When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012429HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012430SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12431from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12432will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12433will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012434
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012435A few things important to notice:
12436 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12437 first valid response.
12438
12439 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12440 servers return an error.
12441
12442
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124435.3.2. The resolvers section
12444----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012445
12446This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012447HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12448contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012449
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012450When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12451uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12452is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12453answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12454
12455When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012456used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012457
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012458 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12459 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12460 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012461
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012462 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12463 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012464
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012465 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12466 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12467 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012468
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012469For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12470following scenarios are possible:
12471
12472 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12473 ignored
12474
12475 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12476 applied
12477
12478 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12479 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12480
12481 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12482 retries the query with a new type
12483
12484 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12485 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012486
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012487As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12488a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012489<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012490
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012491
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012492resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012493 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012494
12495A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12496
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012497accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012498 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012499 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012500 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12501 by RFC 6891)
12502
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012503 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12504
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012505nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12506 DNS server description:
12507 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12508 <ip> : IP address of the server
12509 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12510
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012511parse-resolv-conf
12512 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12513 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12514 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12515
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012516hold <status> <period>
12517 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12518 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012519 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012520 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012521 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12522 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12523 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12524
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012525 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012526
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012527resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012528 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12529 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12530 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12531
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012532resolve_retries <nb>
12533 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12534 giving up.
12535 Default value: 3
12536
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012537 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12538 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12539 type.
12540
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012541timeout <event> <time>
12542 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12543 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12544 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012545 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12546 other time applied.
12547 Default value: 1s
12548 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12549 have been received.
12550 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012551 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12552 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12553
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012554 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012555
12556 resolvers mydns
12557 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12558 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012559 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012560 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012561 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012562 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012563 hold other 30s
12564 hold refused 30s
12565 hold nx 30s
12566 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012567 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012568 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012569
12570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125716. HTTP header manipulation
12572---------------------------
12573
12574In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12575response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12576request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12577which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012578against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012579
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012580If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12581to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12582but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12583HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12584stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12585because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12586a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12587still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012589This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12590in section 4.2 :
12591
12592 - reqadd <string>
12593 - reqallow <search>
12594 - reqiallow <search>
12595 - reqdel <search>
12596 - reqidel <search>
12597 - reqdeny <search>
12598 - reqideny <search>
12599 - reqpass <search>
12600 - reqipass <search>
12601 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12602 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12603 - reqtarpit <search>
12604 - reqitarpit <search>
12605 - rspadd <string>
12606 - rspdel <search>
12607 - rspidel <search>
12608 - rspdeny <search>
12609 - rspideny <search>
12610 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12611 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12612
12613With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12614is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12615parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12616prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12617Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12618
12619 \t for a tab
12620 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12621 \n for a new line (LF)
12622 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12623 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12624 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12625 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12626 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12627
12628The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12629portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12630above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12631regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
126329 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12633is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12634
12635The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12636after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12637
12638Notes related to these keywords :
12639---------------------------------
12640 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12641 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12642 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12643
12644 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12645 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12646 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12647
12648 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12649 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12650 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12651 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12652 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12653
12654 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12655 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12656 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12657 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12658 useless headers before adding new ones.
12659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012660 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012661 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12662
12663 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12664 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12665 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12666
12667 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12668 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012669 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012670
12671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126727. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12673----------------------------------
12674
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012675HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012676client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12677The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12678these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12679but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12680data called patterns.
12681
12682
126837.1. ACL basics
12684---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012685
12686The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12687content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12688from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12689simple :
12690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012691 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012692 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012693 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12694 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012696The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12697adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012698
12699In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012701 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012702
12703This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12704Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12705and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012706an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12707conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12708as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12709are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012710
12711ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12712'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12713which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12714
12715There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12716performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012718The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12719specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12720this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012721methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12722ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012723
12724Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12725 - boolean
12726 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12727 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12728 - string
12729 - data block
12730
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012731Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12732converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12733would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12734The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12735which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12736
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012737Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12738keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12739fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12740which are summarized in the table below :
12741
12742 +---------------------+-----------------+
12743 | Sample or converter | Default |
12744 | output type | matching method |
12745 +---------------------+-----------------+
12746 | boolean | bool |
12747 +---------------------+-----------------+
12748 | integer | int |
12749 +---------------------+-----------------+
12750 | ip | ip |
12751 +---------------------+-----------------+
12752 | string | str |
12753 +---------------------+-----------------+
12754 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12755 +---------------------+-----------------+
12756
12757Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12758matching method, see below.
12759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012760The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12761 - boolean
12762 - integer or integer range
12763 - IP address / network
12764 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12765 - regular expression
12766 - hex block
12767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012768The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12769
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012770 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12771 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012772 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012773 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012774 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012775 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012776 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012778The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12779read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12780if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12781lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12782will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12783beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12784a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12785lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12786exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12787
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012788The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12789parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12790ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12791a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12792check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12793
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012794The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12795socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12796file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012798Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12799loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12800
12801 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12802
12803In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12804the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12805case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12806as well.
12807
12808The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12809sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12810do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12811methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12812is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012813obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012814followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12815default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12816that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12817string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12818
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012819The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12820By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12821string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12822resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12823server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12824waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12825flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12826function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012828There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12829sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12830be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012831
12832 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12833 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012834 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12835 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12836 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12837 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012838
12839 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12840 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012841 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012842
12843 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012844 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012845
12846 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012847 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012848
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012849 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012850 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12851
12852 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12853 binary or string samples.
12854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012855 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12856 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012858 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12859 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12860 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012862 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12863 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012865 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12866 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012868 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12869 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012871 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12872 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012873 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012875 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12876 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12877 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012878
12879For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12880request, it is possible to do :
12881
12882 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12883
12884In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12885buffer, one would use the following acl :
12886
12887 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12888
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012889On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12890possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12891
12892 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012894All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12895criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12896method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12897to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12898criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12899the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012901If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012902the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12903For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012905 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12906 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12907 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12908 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012909
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012910
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012911The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12912types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12913combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12914brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12915default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012917 +-------------------------------------------------+
12918 | Input sample type |
12919 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012920 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012921 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12922 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12923 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012924 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012925 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012926 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012927 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012928 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012929 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012930 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012931 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012932 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012933 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012934 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012935 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012936 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012937 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012938 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012939 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012940 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012941 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012942 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012943 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012944 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012945 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12946 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12947 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012948
12949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129507.1.1. Matching booleans
12951------------------------
12952
12953In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12954Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12955When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12956that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12957
12958Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12959return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12960"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12961
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129637.1.2. Matching integers
12964------------------------
12965
12966Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12967enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12968to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12969
12970Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12971matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12972lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012973
12974For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12975unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12976representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12977
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012978As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12979two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12980instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12981ranges and operators.
12982
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012983For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012984operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12985Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12986of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012987
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012988Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012989
12990 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12991 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12992 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12993 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12994 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12995
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012996For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012997
12998 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12999
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013000This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13001
13002 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13003
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130057.1.3. Matching strings
13006-----------------------
13007
13008String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13009different forms :
13010
13011 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013012 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013013
13014 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013015 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013016
13017 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13018 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13019
13020 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13021 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13022
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013023 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013024 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13025 matches.
13026
13027 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13028 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13029 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013030
13031String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13032exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13033characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13034string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13035to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013036before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013037
13038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130397.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13040---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013041
13042Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13043they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13044possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13045passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13046the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013047the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13048match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013049
13050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130517.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13052-------------------------------------
13053
13054It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13055not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13056a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13057to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13058digits may be used upper or lower case.
13059
13060Example :
13061 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13062 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13063
13064
130657.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13066---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013067
13068IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13069netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13070within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013071host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013072difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13073at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13074does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13075parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013076
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013077The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13078abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13079
13080 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13081 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13082 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13083 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13084 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13085 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13086 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13087 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13088
13089Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13090192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13091
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013092IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13093Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13094trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13095IPv6 patterns.
13096
13097HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13098following situations :
13099 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13100 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13101 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13102 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13103 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13104 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13105 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13106 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13107 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13108 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013110
131117.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13112----------------------------------
13113
13114Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13115combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13116
13117 - AND (implicit)
13118 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13119 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013121A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013123 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013125Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13126indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013128For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13129"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13130requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13131is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13132
13133 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013134 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13135 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13136 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013137
13138To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13139and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13140
13141 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13142 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13143 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13144 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13145
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013146 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013147 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13148 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13149 use_backend www if host_www
13150
13151It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13152expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13153be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13154the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13155
13156 The following rule :
13157
13158 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013159 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013160
13161 Can also be written that way :
13162
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013163 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013164
13165It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13166to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13167simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13168sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13169good use is the following :
13170
13171 With named ACLs :
13172
13173 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13174 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13175 monitor fail if site_dead
13176
13177 With anonymous ACLs :
13178
13179 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13180
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013181See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13182keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013183
13184
131857.3. Fetching samples
13186---------------------
13187
13188Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13189against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13190sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13191ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13192of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13193available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13194
13195This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13196Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13197compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13198deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13199
13200The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13201matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13202method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13203indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13204
13205As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13206when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13207mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13208the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13209ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13210
13211Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13212multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13213when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013214incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13215are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013216is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13217all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13218
13219Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13220 - name
13221 - name(arg1)
13222 - name(arg1,arg2)
13223
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013224
132257.3.1. Converters
13226-----------------
13227
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013228Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13229of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13230is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13231was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013232has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013233unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13234
13235These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13236sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13237the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013238support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013239
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013240A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13241support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13242supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13243(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13244bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013246The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013247
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001324851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13249 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13250 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13251 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13252 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13253 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13254
13255 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013256 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13257 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013258 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13259 frontend http-in
13260 bind *:8081
13261 default_backend servers
13262 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13263 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13264
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013265add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013266 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013267 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013268 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13269 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013270 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013271 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13272 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13273 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13274 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013275 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013276 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013277
13278and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013279 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013280 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013281 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13282 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013283 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013284 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13285 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13286 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13287 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013288 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013289 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013290
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013291b64dec
13292 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13293 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13294
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013295base64
13296 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013297 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013298 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13299
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013300bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013301 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013302 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013303 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013304 presence of a flag).
13305
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013306bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13307 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13308 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013309 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013310
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013311concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13312 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13313 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13314 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13315 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13316 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13317 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13318 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13319 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13320 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13321 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13322 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13323 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13324 delimitors.
13325
13326 Example:
13327 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13328 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13329 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13330 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13331
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013332cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013333 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13334 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013335
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013336crc32([<avalanche>])
13337 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13338 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13339 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13340 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13341 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13342 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13343 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13344 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13345 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13346 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013347 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13348
13349crc32c([<avalanche>])
13350 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13351 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13352 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13353 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13354 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13355 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13356 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13357 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013358
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013359da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013360 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13361 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13362 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13363 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013364 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013365 configuration language.
13366
13367 Example:
13368 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013369 bind *:8881
13370 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013371 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013372
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013373debug
13374 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13375 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13376 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13377
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013378div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013379 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13380 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013381 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013382 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13383 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013384 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013385 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13386 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13387 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13388 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013389 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013390 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013391
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013392djb2([<avalanche>])
13393 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13394 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13395 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13396 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13397 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13398 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13399 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013400 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13401 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013402
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013403even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013404 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013405 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13406
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013407field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13408 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13409 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13410 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13411 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13412 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13413 fields.
13414
13415 Example :
13416 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13417 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13418 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13419 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13420 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013421
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013422hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013423 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013424 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013425 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013426 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013427
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013428hex2i
13429 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13430 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13431
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013432http_date([<offset>])
13433 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13434 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13435 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13436 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13437 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13438 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013439
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013440in_table(<table>)
13441 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13442 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13443 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013444 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013445 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13446
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013447ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13448 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013449 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013450 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13451 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13452 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13453 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13454 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013455
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013456json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013457 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013458 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013459 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013460 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13461 of errors:
13462 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13463 bytes, ...)
13464 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13465 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13466
13467 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13468 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13469 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13470 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13471 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13472 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013473 - "ascii" : never fails;
13474 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13475 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013476 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013477 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013478 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13479 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13480
13481 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013482 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013483
13484 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013485 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013486 capture request header user-agent len 150
13487 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013488
13489 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13490 GET / HTTP/1.0
13491 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13492
13493 Output log:
13494 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13495
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013496language(<value>[,<default>])
13497 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13498 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13499 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13500 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13501 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13502 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13503 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13504 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13505 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013506 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013507 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13508 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013509
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013510 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013511
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013512 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13513 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013514
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013515 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13516 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13517 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13518 use_backend spanish if es
13519 use_backend french if fr
13520 use_backend english if en
13521 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013522
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013523length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013524 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13525 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13526 type. The result is of type integer.
13527
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013528lower
13529 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13530 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13531 type. The result is of type string.
13532
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013533ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13534 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13535 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13536 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13537 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13538 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13539 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13540
13541 Example :
13542
13543 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013544 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013545 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13546
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013547map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13548map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13549map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13550 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13551 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13552 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13553 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13554 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13555 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13556 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13557 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013558
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013559 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13560 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13561 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013562
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013563 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013564 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013565
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013566 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13567 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13568 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13569 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013570 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13571 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013572 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13573 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13574 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13575 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13576 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13577 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13578 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13579 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013580 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13581 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13582 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013583 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13584 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13585 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13586 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13587 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013588
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013589 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13590 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13591 the corresponding match text.
13592
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013593 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13594 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13595 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13596 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13597 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013598
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013599 Example :
13600
13601 # this is a comment and is ignored
13602 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13603 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13604 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13605 | | | `---------- value
13606 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13607 | `---------------------------- key
13608 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13609
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013610mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013611 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13612 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013613 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013614 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013615 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013616 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13617 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13618 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13619 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013620 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013621 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013622
13623mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013624 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013625 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13626 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013627 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013628 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013629 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013630 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13631 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13632 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13633 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013634 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013635 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013636
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013637nbsrv
13638 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13639 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13640 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13641 map lookup.
13642
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013643neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013644 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13645 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13646 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13647 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013648
13649not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013650 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013651 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013652 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013653 absence of a flag).
13654
13655odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013656 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013657 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13658
13659or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013660 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013661 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013662 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13663 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013664 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013665 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13666 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13667 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13668 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013669 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013670 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013671
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013672regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013673 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13674 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13675 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13676 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13677 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13678 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13679 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13680 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13681 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13682 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013683 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13684 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13685 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13686 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013687
13688 Example :
13689
13690 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13691 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13692 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13693 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13694
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013695capture-req(<id>)
13696 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13697 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13698
13699 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013700 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13701 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013702
13703capture-res(<id>)
13704 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13705 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13706
13707 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013708 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13709 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013710
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013711sdbm([<avalanche>])
13712 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13713 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13714 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13715 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13716 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13717 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13718 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013719 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13720 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013721
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013722set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013723 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13724 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13725 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013726 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013727 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13728 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013729 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013730 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13731 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013732 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013733 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013734
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013735sha1
13736 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13737 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13738
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013739strcmp(<var>)
13740 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13741 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13742 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13743 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13744 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13745 shorter).
13746
13747 Example :
13748
13749 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13750 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13751 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13752
13753
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013754sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013755 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13756 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013757 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013758 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13759 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013760 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013761 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13762 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013763 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013764 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13765 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013766 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013767 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013768
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010013769svarint
13770 Converts a binary input sample of a protocol buffers signed "varints" ("sint32"
13771 and "sint64") to an integer.
13772 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message types:
13773 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13774
13775varint
13776 Converts a binary input sample of a protocol buffers "varints", excepted
13777 the signed ones "sint32" and "sint64", to an integer.
13778 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message types:
13779 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13780
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013781table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13782 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13783 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13784 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13785 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13786 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13787 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13788
13789
13790table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13791 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13792 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13793 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13794 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13795 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13796 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13797
13798table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13799 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13800 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013801 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013802 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13803 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13804
13805table_conn_cur(<table>)
13806 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13807 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13808 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13809 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13810 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13811
13812table_conn_rate(<table>)
13813 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13814 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13815 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13816 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13817 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13818
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013819table_gpt0(<table>)
13820 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13821 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13822 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13823 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13824 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13825
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013826table_gpc0(<table>)
13827 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13828 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13829 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13830 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13831 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13832
13833table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13834 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13835 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13836 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13837 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13838 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13839 sample fetch keyword.
13840
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013841table_gpc1(<table>)
13842 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13843 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13844 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13845 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13846 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13847
13848table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13849 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13850 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13851 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13852 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13853 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13854 sample fetch keyword.
13855
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013856table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13857 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13858 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013859 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013860 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13861 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13862
13863table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13864 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13865 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13866 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13867 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13868 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13869 keyword.
13870
13871table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13872 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13873 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013874 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013875 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13876 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13877
13878table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13879 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13880 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13881 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13882 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13883 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13884 keyword.
13885
13886table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13887 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13888 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013889 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013890 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13891 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13892 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13893 keyword.
13894
13895table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13896 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13897 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013898 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013899 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13900 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13901 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13902 keyword.
13903
13904table_server_id(<table>)
13905 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13906 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13907 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13908 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13909 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13910 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13911
13912table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13913 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13914 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013915 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013916 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13917 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13918 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13919 keyword.
13920
13921table_sess_rate(<table>)
13922 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13923 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13924 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13925 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13926 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13927 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13928 keyword.
13929
13930table_trackers(<table>)
13931 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13932 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13933 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13934 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13935 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13936 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13937 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13938 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13939 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13940 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13941
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013942upper
13943 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13944 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13945 type. The result is of type string.
13946
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013947url_dec
13948 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13949 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13950
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013951unset-var(<var name>)
13952 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13953 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13954 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13955 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13956 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13957 response),
13958 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13959 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13960 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13961 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13962
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013963utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13964 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13965 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13966 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13967 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13968 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13969 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13970
13971 Example :
13972
13973 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013974 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013975 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13976
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013977word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13978 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13979 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13980 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13981 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13982 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13983
13984 Example :
13985 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13986 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13987 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13988 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13989 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013990
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013991wt6([<avalanche>])
13992 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13993 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13994 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13995 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13996 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13997 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13998 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013999 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14000 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014001
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014002xor(<value>)
14003 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014004 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014005 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014006 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014007 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014008 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14009 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014010 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014011 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14012 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014013 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014014 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014015
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014016xxh32([<seed>])
14017 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14018 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14019 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14020 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14021 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14022 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14023 as cryptographically secure.
14024
14025xxh64([<seed>])
14026 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14027 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14028 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14029 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14030 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14031 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14032 as cryptographically secure.
14033
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014034
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140357.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014036--------------------------------------------
14037
14038A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14039not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14040"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14041The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14042
14043always_false : boolean
14044 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14045 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14046
14047always_true : boolean
14048 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14049 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14050
14051avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014052 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014053 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14054 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14055 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14056 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14057 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14058 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14059 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14060 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14061 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14062 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14063 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14064 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14065 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014067be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014068 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14069 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14070 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14071 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014072 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14073
14074be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14075 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14076 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14077 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14078 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14079 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014080 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14081 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014082
14083 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14084 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14085 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014087be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14088 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14089 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14090 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014091 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014092 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14093 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014094
14095 Example :
14096 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14097 backend dynamic
14098 mode http
14099 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14100 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014101
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014102bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014103 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14104 of the string.
14105
14106bool(<bool>) : bool
14107 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14108 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014110connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14111 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014112 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014113 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14114 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014115
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014116 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014117 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014118 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14119
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014120 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14121 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014122
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014123 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014124 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014125 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014126 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014127 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014128 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014129 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014130
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014131 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14132 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014133 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014134 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014135
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014136cpu_calls : integer
14137 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14138 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14139 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14140 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14141 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14142 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14143
14144cpu_ns_avg : integer
14145 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14146 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14147 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14148 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14149 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14150 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14151 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14152 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14153 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14154 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14155 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14156
14157cpu_ns_tot : integer
14158 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14159 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14160 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14161 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14162 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14163 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14164 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14165 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14166 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14167 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14168 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14169 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14170 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14171
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014172date([<offset>]) : integer
14173 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14174 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14175 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14176 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014177 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14178
14179 Example :
14180
14181 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14182 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014183
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014184date_us : integer
14185 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14186 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14187 from the same timeval structure.
14188
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014189distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14190 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14191 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14192 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14193 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14194 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14195 list of supported tokens.
14196
14197distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14198 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14199 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14200 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14201 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14202 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14203 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14204 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14205 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14206 supported tokens.
14207
14208 Example :
14209 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14210 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14211 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14212 # send large files to the big farm
14213 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14214
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014215env(<name>) : string
14216 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14217 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14218 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14219 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14220 certain way.
14221
14222 Examples :
14223 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14224 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14225
14226 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14227 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014229fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14230 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014231 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14232 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014233 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14234 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014235 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014236 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14237 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014238
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014239fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14240 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14241 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14242 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014244fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14245 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14246 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14247 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14248 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14249 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14250 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14251 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14252 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014253
14254 Example :
14255 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14256 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14257 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14258 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14259 frontend mail
14260 bind :25
14261 mode tcp
14262 maxconn 100
14263 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14264 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14265 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14266 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014267
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014268hostname : string
14269 Returns the system hostname.
14270
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014271int(<integer>) : signed integer
14272 Returns a signed integer.
14273
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014274ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14275 Returns an ipv4.
14276
14277ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14278 Returns an ipv6.
14279
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014280lat_ns_avg : integer
14281 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14282 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14283 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14284 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14285 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14286 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14287 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14288 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14289 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14290 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14291 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14292 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14293 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14294 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14295
14296lat_ns_tot : integer
14297 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14298 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14299 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14300 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14301 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14302 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14303 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14304 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14305 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14306 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14307 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14308 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14309 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14310 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14311 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14312 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14313 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14314 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14315 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14316
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014317meth(<method>) : method
14318 Returns a method.
14319
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014320nbproc : integer
14321 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14322 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14323 and debugging purposes.
14324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014325nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14326 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14327 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14328 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014329 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14330 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14331 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014332
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014333prio_class : integer
14334 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14335 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14336 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14337
14338prio_offset : integer
14339 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14340 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14341 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14342 set-priority-offset".
14343
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014344proc : integer
14345 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14346 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14347 debugging purposes.
14348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014349queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014350 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14351 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14352 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014353 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14354 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14355 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14356 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14357 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14358
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014359rand([<range>]) : integer
14360 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14361 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14362 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14363 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14364 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014366srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14367 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14368 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14369 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14370 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14371 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014372 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14373 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14374
14375srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14376 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14377 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14378 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14379 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14380 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14381 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14382 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14383
14384 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14385 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014386
14387srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14388 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14389 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14390 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014391 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014392 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14393 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14394 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14395
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014396srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14397 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14398 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14399 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14400 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14401 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14402 fetch methods.
14403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014404srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14405 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14406 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014407 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014408 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14409 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014410 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014411 overloading servers).
14412
14413 Example :
14414 # Redirect to a separate back
14415 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14416 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14417 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14418
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014419stopping : boolean
14420 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14421 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14422 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14423
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014424str(<string>) : string
14425 Returns a string.
14426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014427table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14428 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14429 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14430
14431table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14432 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14433 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14434 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14435
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014436thread : integer
14437 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14438 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14439 and debugging purposes.
14440
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014441var(<var-name>) : undefined
14442 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014443 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14444 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014445 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014446 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14447 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014448 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014449 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14450 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014451 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014452 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014453
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144547.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014455----------------------------------
14456
14457The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14458closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14459methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14460sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14461TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014462the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14463counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014464"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14465used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14466can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14467Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14468table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14469tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14470currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014471
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014472bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014473 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14474 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14475 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014477be_id : integer
14478 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14479 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14480
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014481be_name : string
14482 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14483 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014485dst : ip
14486 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14487 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14488 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14489 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014490 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14491 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14492 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14493 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14494 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14495 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496
14497dst_conn : integer
14498 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14499 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14500 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14501 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14502 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14503 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14504 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14505 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014506
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014507dst_is_local : boolean
14508 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14509 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14510 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14511 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014512 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014513 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14514 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14515 it only once per connection.
14516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014517dst_port : integer
14518 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14519 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14520 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14521 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14522 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14523 an HTTP header.
14524
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014525fc_http_major : integer
14526 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14527 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14528 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14529
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014530fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14531 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14532 header.
14533
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014534fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14535 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14536 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14537 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14538 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14539 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14540 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14541
14542fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14543 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14544 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14545 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14546 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14547 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14548 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14549
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014550fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14551 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14552 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14553 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14554 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14555
14556fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14557 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14558 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14559 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14560 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14561
14562fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14563 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14564 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14565 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14566 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14567
14568fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14569 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14570 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14571 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14572 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14573
14574fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14575 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14576 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14577 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14578 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14579
14580fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14581 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14582 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14583 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14584 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14585
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014586fe_defbe : string
14587 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14588 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014590fe_id : integer
14591 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014592 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014593 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14594
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014595fe_name : string
14596 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14597 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14598 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14599
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014600sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014601sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14602sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14603sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014604 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14605 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14606 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14607
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014608sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014609sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14610sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14611sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014612 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14613 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14614 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14615
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014616sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014617sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14618sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14619sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014620 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14621 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014622 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14623 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14624 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014625
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014626 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014627 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14628 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014629 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14630 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14631 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014632 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14633 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14634
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014635sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14636sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14637sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14638sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14639 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14640 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14641 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14642 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14643 when a first ACL was verified.
14644
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014645sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014646sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14647sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14648sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014649 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014650 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14651
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014652sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014653sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14654sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14655sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014656 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14657 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14658 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14659
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014660sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014661sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14662sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14663sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014664 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14665 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14666 See also src_conn_rate.
14667
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014668sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014669sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14670sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14671sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014672 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014673 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014674
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014675sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14676sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14677sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14678sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14679 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14680 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14681
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014682sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14683sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14684sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14685sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14686 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14687 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14688
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014689sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014690sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14691sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14692sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014693 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14694 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14695 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014696 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14697 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14698 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014699
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014700sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14701sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14702sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14703sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14704 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14705 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14706 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14707 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14708 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14709 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14710
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014711sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014712sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14713sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14714sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014715 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014716 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14717 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14718
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014719sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014720sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14721sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14722sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014723 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14724 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14725 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14726 src_http_err_rate.
14727
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014728sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014729sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14730sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14731sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014732 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014733 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14734 src_http_req_cnt.
14735
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014736sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014737sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14738sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14739sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014740 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14741 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14742 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14743 src_http_req_rate.
14744
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014745sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014746sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14747sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14748sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014749 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014750 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14751 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14752 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14753 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014754
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014755 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014756 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14757 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014758 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14759
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014760sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14761sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14762sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14763sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14764 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14765 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14766 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14767 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14768 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14769
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014770sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014771sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14772sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14773sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014774 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14775 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14776 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014777
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014778sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014779sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14780sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14781sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014782 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14783 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14784 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014785
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014786sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014787sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14788sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14789sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014790 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014791 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14792 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14793 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014794 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014795 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14796
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014797sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014798sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14799sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14800sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014801 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14802 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14803 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14804 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14805 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014806 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014807
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014808sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014809sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14810sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14811sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014812 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14813 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14814 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14815
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014816sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014817sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14818sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14819sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014820 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14821 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014822 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014823 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14824 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14826 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14827 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014829so_id : integer
14830 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14831 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14832 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014835 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014836 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14837 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14838 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014839 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14840 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14841 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014842 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14843 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14844 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14845 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14846 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14847 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14848 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014849
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014850 Example:
14851 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14852 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014854src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14855 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14856 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14857 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014858 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014860src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14861 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14862 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014863 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014864 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14867 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14868 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14869 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14870 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14871 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14872 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014873
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014874 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014875 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14876 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14877 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14878 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014879 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014880 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14881 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14882
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014883src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14884 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14885 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14886 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14887 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14888 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14889 was verified.
14890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014891src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014892 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014893 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014894 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014895 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014897src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014898 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014899 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14900 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014901 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014903src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14904 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14905 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14906 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014907 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014909src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014910 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014911 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014912 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014913 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014914
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014915src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14916 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14917 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14918 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14919 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14920
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014921src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14922 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14923 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14924 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14925 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014928 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014929 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014930 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14931 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014932 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14933 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14934 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014935
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014936src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14937 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14938 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14939 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14940 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14941 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14942 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14943 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014945src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014946 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014947 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014948 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014949 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014952src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14953 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14954 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14955 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14956 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014957 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014959src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014960 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014961 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14962 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014963 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014965src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14966 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14967 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14968 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014969 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014970 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014972src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14973 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14974 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14975 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014976 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014977 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14978 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014979
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014980 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014981 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014982 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014983 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014984
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014985src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14986 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14987 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14988 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14989 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14990 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14991 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14992
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014993src_is_local : boolean
14994 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14995 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14996 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14997 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014998 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014999 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15000 once per connection.
15001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015002src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015003 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15004 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15005 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15006 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15007 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015009src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015010 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15011 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15012 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15013 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15014 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015016src_port : integer
15017 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15018 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15019 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15020 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015022src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015023 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015024 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15025 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15026 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015027 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015029src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15030 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15031 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15032 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15033 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015034 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015036src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15037 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15038 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15039 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15040 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15041 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15042 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15043 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15044 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015045
15046 Example :
15047 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15048 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15049 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15050 listen ssh
15051 bind :22
15052 mode tcp
15053 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015054 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015055 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015056 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015058srv_id : integer
15059 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15060 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15061 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015062
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150637.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015064----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015066The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15067closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15068when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15069usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015070future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015071
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001507251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15073 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15074 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15075 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15076 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15077 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15078
15079 Example :
15080 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15081 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15082 # the request.
15083 frontend http-in
15084 bind *:8081
15085 default_backend servers
15086 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15087 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15088
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015089ssl_bc : boolean
15090 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15091 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15092 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15093
15094ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15095 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15096 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15097
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015098ssl_bc_alpn : string
15099 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15100 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15101 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15102 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15103 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15104 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15105 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15106 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15107 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15108
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015109ssl_bc_cipher : string
15110 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15111 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15112
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015113ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15114 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15115 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15116 session or a TLS ticket.
15117
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015118ssl_bc_npn : string
15119 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15120 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15121 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15122 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15123 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15124 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15125 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15126 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15127
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015128ssl_bc_protocol : string
15129 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15130 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15131
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015132ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015133 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015134 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15135 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015136
15137ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15138 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15139 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15140 if session was reused or not.
15141
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015142ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15143 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15144 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15145 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15146 BoringSSL.
15147
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015148ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15149 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15150 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015152ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15153 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15154 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15155 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15156 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15157 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015159ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15160 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15161 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15162 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15163 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015164
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015165ssl_c_der : binary
15166 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15167 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15168 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015170ssl_c_err : integer
15171 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15172 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15173 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15174 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15175 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015177ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15178 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15179 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15180 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15181 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15182 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15183 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15184 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15185 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187ssl_c_key_alg : string
15188 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15189 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15190 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015192ssl_c_notafter : string
15193 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15194 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15195 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015197ssl_c_notbefore : string
15198 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15199 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15200 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15203 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15204 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15205 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15206 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15207 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15208 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15209 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15210 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015212ssl_c_serial : binary
15213 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15214 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15215 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015217ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15218 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15219 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15220 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015221 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15222 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15223
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015224 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015225 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015227ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15228 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15229 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15230 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232ssl_c_used : boolean
15233 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15234 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236ssl_c_verify : integer
15237 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15238 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15239 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15240 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015242ssl_c_version : integer
15243 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15244 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015245
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015246ssl_f_der : binary
15247 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15248 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15249 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15252 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15253 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15254 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15255 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015256 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015257 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15258 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15259 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015261ssl_f_key_alg : string
15262 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15263 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15264 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266ssl_f_notafter : string
15267 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15268 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15269 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015271ssl_f_notbefore : string
15272 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15273 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15274 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015276ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15277 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15278 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15279 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15280 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15281 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15282 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15283 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15284 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015286ssl_f_serial : binary
15287 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15288 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15289 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015290
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015291ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15292 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15293 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15294 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015296ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15297 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15298 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15299 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015301ssl_f_version : integer
15302 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15303 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15304
15305ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015306 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15307 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15308 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015310 Example :
15311 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15312 listen http-https
15313 bind :80
15314 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15315 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15316
15317ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15318 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15319 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15320
15321ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015322 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015323 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15324 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15325 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15326 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15327 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15328 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15329 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15330 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015332ssl_fc_cipher : string
15333 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15334 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015335
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015336ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15337 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15338 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015339 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015340
15341ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15342 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15343 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015344 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015345
15346ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15347 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15348 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15349 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015350 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015351 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015352
15353ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15354 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15355 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015356 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015358ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015359 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15360 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015361 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15362 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15363 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15364 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015365
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015366ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15367 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15368 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15369 wait until the handshake happened.
15370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015371ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15372 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015373 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15374 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15375 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15376 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015377
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015378ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015379 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015380 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15381 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015383ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015384 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015385 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15386 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15387 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15388 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15389 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15390 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15391 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015393ssl_fc_protocol : string
15394 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15395 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015396
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015397ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015398 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015399 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15400 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015402ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15403 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15404 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15405 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15406 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015407
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015408ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15409 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15410 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15411 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15412 BoringSSL.
15413
15414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015415ssl_fc_sni : string
15416 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15417 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15418 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15419 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15420 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15421
15422 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15423 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15424 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015425 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15426 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015428 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015429 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15430 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015432ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15433 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15434 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015435
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015436
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154377.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015438------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015440Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15441sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15442only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15443For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15444be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15445can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15446sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15447for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15448content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015450payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015451 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015452 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15453 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15456 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015457 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015459
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015460req.hdrs : string
15461 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15462 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15463 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15464 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15465
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015466req.hdrs_bin : binary
15467 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15468 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15469 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15470 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15471 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15472 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15473
15474 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15475
15476 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15477 str: <int:length><bytes>
15478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479req.len : integer
15480req_len : integer (deprecated)
15481 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15482 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15483 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15484 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15485 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15486 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15487 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15488 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15491 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015492 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15493 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15494 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15495 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015497 ACL alternatives :
15498 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015500req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15501 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15502 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15503 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15504 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015506 ACL alternatives :
15507 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511req.proto_http : boolean
15512req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15513 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15514 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15515 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15516 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15517 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15518 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15519 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015521 Example:
15522 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15523 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15524 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015525 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15528rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15529 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15530 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15531 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15532 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15533 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15534 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15535 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015537 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15538 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15539 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15540 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15541 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15542 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544 ACL derivatives :
15545 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547 Example :
15548 listen tse-farm
15549 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15550 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15551 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15552 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15553 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15554 persist rdp-cookie
15555 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15556 # This is only useful makes sense if
15557 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15558 stick-table type string size 204800
15559 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15560 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15561 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15564 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015566req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15567rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15568 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15569 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15570 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15571 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573 ACL derivatives :
15574 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015575
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015576req.ssl_alpn : string
15577 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15578 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15579 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15580 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15581 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15582 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015583 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015584
15585 Examples :
15586 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15587 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15588 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015589 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015590 default_backend bk_default
15591
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015592req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15593 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15594 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015595 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15596 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15597 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15598 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15599 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15602req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15603 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15604 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15605 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15606 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15607 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15608 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15609 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015611req.ssl_sni : string
15612req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15613 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15614 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15615 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15616 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15617 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15618 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15619 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15620 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15621 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15622 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15623 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15624 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626 ACL derivatives :
15627 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629 Examples :
15630 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15631 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15632 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15633 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15634 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015635
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015636req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15637 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15638 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15639 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15640 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15641 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15642 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15643 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15644 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15645 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647req.ssl_ver : integer
15648req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15649 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15650 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15651 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15652 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15653 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15654 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15655 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015656 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659 ACL derivatives :
15660 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015661
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015662res.len : integer
15663 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15664 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15665 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15666 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15667 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15668 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15669 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15670 content inspection.
15671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15673 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015674 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15675 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15676 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15677 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15680 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15681 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15682 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15683 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015686
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015687res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15688rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15689 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15690 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15691 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15692 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15693 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15694 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15695 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697wait_end : boolean
15698 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15699 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015700 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015701 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15702 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015703 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15705 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707 Examples :
15708 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15709 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15710 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15713 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15714 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15715 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15716 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15717 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15718 tcp-request content reject
15719
15720
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157217.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722--------------------------------------
15723
15724It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15725This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15726data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15727its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15728HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15729content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15730to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15731more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15732response are indexed.
15733
15734base : string
15735 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15736 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15737 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15738 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15739 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15740 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15741 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15742 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15743
15744 ACL derivatives :
15745 base : exact string match
15746 base_beg : prefix match
15747 base_dir : subdir match
15748 base_dom : domain match
15749 base_end : suffix match
15750 base_len : length match
15751 base_reg : regex match
15752 base_sub : substring match
15753
15754base32 : integer
15755 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15756 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15757 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015758 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15759 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15760 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015761
15762base32+src : binary
15763 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15764 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15765 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15766 per-URL counters.
15767
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015768capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15769 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15770 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15771 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15772
15773capture.req.method : string
15774 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15775 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15776 because it's allocated.
15777
15778capture.req.uri : string
15779 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15780 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15781 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15782 allocated.
15783
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015784capture.req.ver : string
15785 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15786 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15787 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15788
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015789capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15790 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15791 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15792 The first entry is an index of 0.
15793 See also: "capture response header"
15794
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015795capture.res.ver : string
15796 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15797 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15798 persistent flag.
15799
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015800req.body : binary
15801 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15802 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15803 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15804 the first chunk is analyzed.
15805
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015806req.body_param([<name>) : string
15807 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15808 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15809 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15810 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15811 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15812 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15813 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15814 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15815 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15816 given.
15817
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015818req.body_len : integer
15819 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15820 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15821 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15822 "option http-buffer-request".
15823
15824req.body_size : integer
15825 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15826 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15827 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15828 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15829 "option http-buffer-request".
15830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831req.cook([<name>]) : string
15832cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15833 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15834 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15835 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15836 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15837 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15838 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15839 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15840 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15841
15842 ACL derivatives :
15843 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15844 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15845 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15846 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15847 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15848 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15849 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15850 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15853cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15854 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15855 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015857req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15858cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15859 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15860 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15861 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15862 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015864cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15865 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15866 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15867 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15868 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015869 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015870 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15871 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15872 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15873 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015875hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15876 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15877 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15878 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15879 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015880 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015882req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15883 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15884 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15885 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15886 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15887 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15888 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15889 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15890 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15893 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15894 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15895 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15896 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15899 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15900 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15901 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15902 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15903 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15904 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15905 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15906 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015907 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015909 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015911 ACL derivatives :
15912 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15913 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15914 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15915 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15916 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15917 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15918 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15919 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15920
15921req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15922hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15923 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15924 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15925 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15926 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15927 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15928 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15929 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15930 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15931 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15932
15933req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15934hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15935 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15936 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15937 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15938 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15939 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015940 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015941 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15942 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15943
15944req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15945hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15946 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15947 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15948 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15949 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15950 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15951 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15952 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15953
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015954req.ungrpc(<field_number>) : binary
15955 This extracts the protocol buffers message in raw mode of a gRPC request body
15956 with <field_number> as terminal field number (dotted notation).
15957
15958 Example:
15959 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15960 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15961
15962 message Point {
15963 int32 latitude = 1;
15964 int32 longitude = 2;
15965 }
15966
15967 message PPoint {
15968 Point point = 59;
15969 }
15970
15971 message Rectangle {
15972 // One corner of the rectangle.
15973 PPoint lo = 48;
15974 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15975 PPoint hi = 49;
15976 }
15977
15978 Let's say a body requests is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15979 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers messages could be fetched
15980 with this "req.ungrpc" sample fetch directives:
15981
15982 req.ungrpc(48.59.1) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15983 req.ungrpc(48.59.2) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15984 req.ungrpc(49.59.1) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
15985 req.ungrpc(49.59.2) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15986
15987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015988http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15989 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15990 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15991 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15992 basic auth is supported.
15993
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015994http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15995 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15996 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15997 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15998 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16000 basic auth is supported.
16001
16002 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016003 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16004 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16005 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16006 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007
16008http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016009 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16010 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16012 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014method : integer + string
16015 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16016 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16017 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16018 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16019 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16020 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16021 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023 ACL derivatives :
16024 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016026 Example :
16027 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16028 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16029 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031path : string
16032 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16033 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16034 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16035 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16036 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016037 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016038 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016040 ACL derivatives :
16041 path : exact string match
16042 path_beg : prefix match
16043 path_dir : subdir match
16044 path_dom : domain match
16045 path_end : suffix match
16046 path_len : length match
16047 path_reg : regex match
16048 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016049
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016050query : string
16051 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16052 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16053 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16054 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016055 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016056 which stops before the question mark.
16057
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016058req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16059 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16060 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16061 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16062 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064req.ver : string
16065req_ver : string (deprecated)
16066 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16067 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16068 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016070 ACL derivatives :
16071 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016073res.comp : boolean
16074 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16075 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16076 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016078res.comp_algo : string
16079 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16080 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16081 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016083res.cook([<name>]) : string
16084scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16085 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16086 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16087 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016089 ACL derivatives :
16090 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016092res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16093scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16094 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16095 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16096 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016098res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16099scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16100 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16101 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16102 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016104res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16105 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16106 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16107 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16108 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16109 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16110 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16111 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16112 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16113 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16116 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16117 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16118 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16119 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16120 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016122res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16123shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16124 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16125 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16126 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16127 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16128 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16129 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16130 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16131 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016133 ACL derivatives :
16134 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16135 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16136 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16137 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16138 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16139 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16140 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16141 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16142
16143res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16144shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16145 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16146 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16147 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16148 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16149 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016151res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16152shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16153 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16154 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16155 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16156 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16157 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16158 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016159
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016160res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16161 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16162 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16163 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16164 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016166res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16167shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16168 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16169 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16170 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16171 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16172 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16173 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016175res.ver : string
16176resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16177 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16178 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016180 ACL derivatives :
16181 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16184 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16185 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016186 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016187 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16190 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192status : integer
16193 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16194 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16195 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016196
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016197unique-id : string
16198 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16199 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16200 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16201 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16202 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16203 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016205url : string
16206 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16207 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16208 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16209 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16210 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16211 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16212 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016214 ACL derivatives :
16215 url : exact string match
16216 url_beg : prefix match
16217 url_dir : subdir match
16218 url_dom : domain match
16219 url_end : suffix match
16220 url_len : length match
16221 url_reg : regex match
16222 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016224url_ip : ip
16225 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16226 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16227 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16228 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16229 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16230 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16231 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016233url_port : integer
16234 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16235 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16236 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16237 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016238
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016239urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16240url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016241 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16242 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016243 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16244 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16245 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16246 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016247 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16248 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016249 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16250 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252 ACL derivatives :
16253 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16254 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16255 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16256 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16257 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16258 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16259 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16260 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016261
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016263 Example :
16264 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16265 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16266 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16267 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016268
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016269urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016270 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16271 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16272 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016273
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016274url32 : integer
16275 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16276 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16277 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16278 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16279 is an unsigned integer.
16280
16281url32+src : binary
16282 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16283 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16284 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16285
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162877.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016288---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016290Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16291every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016292order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016294ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16295---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016296FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016297HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016298HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16299HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016300HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16301HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16302HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16303HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16304LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016305METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016306METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016307METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16308METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16309METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16310METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016311METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016312METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016313RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016314REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016315TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016316WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16317---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016318
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163208. Logging
16321----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016322
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016323One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16324provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16325very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16326provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16327state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016328to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016329headers.
16330
16331In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16332about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16333send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16334
16335 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16336 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16337 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16338 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16339 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016340 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016341 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016342
16343The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16344allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16345as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16346while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16347real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16348delay.
16349
16350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163518.1. Log levels
16352---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016353
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016354TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016355source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016356HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16357in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16358track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16359syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16360about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016361
16362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163638.2. Log formats
16364----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016365
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016366HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016367and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16368slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16369options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016370
16371 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16372 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16373 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16374 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16375 extents.
16376
16377 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16378 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16379 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16380 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16381 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16382
16383 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16384 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16385 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16386 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16387 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16388
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016389 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16390 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16391 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16392 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16393
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016394 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16395
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016396Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16397specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16398field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16399servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16400always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16401identifier.
16402
16403Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16404 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16405 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16406 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16407 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16408
16409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164108.2.1. Default log format
16411-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016412
16413This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16414as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16415format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16416
16417 Example :
16418 listen www
16419 mode http
16420 log global
16421 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16422
16423 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16424 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16425 (www/HTTP)
16426
16427 Field Format Extract from the example above
16428 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16429 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16430 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16431 4 'to' to
16432 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16433 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16434
16435Detailed fields description :
16436 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16437 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16438 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16439 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16440 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16441 and processed the connection.
16442 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016444In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16445"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16446connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16447
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016448It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16449will eventually disappear.
16450
16451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164528.2.2. TCP log format
16453---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016454
16455The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16456is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16457information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16458counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16459emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16460environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16461the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16462sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016463specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16464not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16465fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16466marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016467
16468 Example :
16469 frontend fnt
16470 mode tcp
16471 option tcplog
16472 log global
16473 default_backend bck
16474
16475 backend bck
16476 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16477
16478 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16479 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16480 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16481
16482 Field Format Extract from the example above
16483 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16484 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16485 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16486 4 frontend_name fnt
16487 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16488 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16489 7 bytes_read* 212
16490 8 termination_state --
16491 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16492 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16493
16494Detailed fields description :
16495 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016496 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16497 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16498 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016499 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016500 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016501 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016502
16503 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016504 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16505 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16506 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016507
16508 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16509 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16510 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016511 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16512 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16513 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16514 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016515
16516 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16517 and processed the connection.
16518
16519 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16520 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16521 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16522 applications.
16523
16524 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16525 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16526 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16527 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16528 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16529
16530 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16531 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16532 See "Timers" below for more details.
16533
16534 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16535 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16536 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16537 "Timers" below for more details.
16538
16539 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016540 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016541 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16542 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16543 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16544 details.
16545
16546 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16547 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16548 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16549 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16550 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16551
16552 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16553 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16554 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16555 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16556 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16557 for more details.
16558
16559 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016560 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016561 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16562 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16563 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016564 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016565
16566 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16567 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16568 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16569 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16570 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16571 caused by a denial of service attack.
16572
16573 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16574 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16575 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16576 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16577 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16578 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16579 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16580 denial of service attack.
16581
16582 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16583 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16584 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16585 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16586 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16587 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16588 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16589 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16590 be processed than on other servers.
16591
16592 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16593 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16594 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16595 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16596 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16597 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16598 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16599 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16600 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16601 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16602 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16603 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16604 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16605
16606 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16607 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16608 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16609 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16610 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16611 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016612 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016613 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16614
16615 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16616 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16617 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16618 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16619 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16620 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016621 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016622 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16623 occurs.
16624
16625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166268.2.3. HTTP log format
16627----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016628
16629The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16630is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16631the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16632are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16633emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16634generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16635"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16636which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016637frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16638is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016639
16640Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16641slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16642with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16643
16644 Example :
16645 frontend http-in
16646 mode http
16647 option httplog
16648 log global
16649 default_backend bck
16650
16651 backend static
16652 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16653
16654 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16655 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16656 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016657 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016658
16659 Field Format Extract from the example above
16660 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16661 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016662 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016663 4 frontend_name http-in
16664 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016665 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016666 7 status_code 200
16667 8 bytes_read* 2750
16668 9 captured_request_cookie -
16669 10 captured_response_cookie -
16670 11 termination_state ----
16671 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16672 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16673 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16674 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16675 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016676
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016677Detailed fields description :
16678 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016679 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16680 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16681 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016682 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016683 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016684 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016685
16686 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016687 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16688 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16689 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016690
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016691 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16692 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016693
16694 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16695 and processed the connection.
16696
16697 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16698 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16699 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16700
16701 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16702 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16703 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16704 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16705 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16706 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16707
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016708 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16709 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16710 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16711 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16712 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16713 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016714 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16715 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016716
16717 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16718 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016719 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016720
16721 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16722 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016723 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16724 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016725
16726 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16727 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16728 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16729 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16730 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016731 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16732 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016733
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016734 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16735 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16736 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16737 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16738 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16739 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16740 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016741 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016742
16743 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16744 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16745 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16746
16747 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16748 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16749 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16750 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16751 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16752 overflowing.
16753
16754 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16755 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16756 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16757 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16758 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16759 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16760 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16761 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16762
16763 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16764 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16765 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16766 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16767 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16768 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16769 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16770 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16771
16772 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16773 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16774 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16775 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16776 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16777 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16778 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16779
16780 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016781 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016782 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16783 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16784 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016785 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016786 system.
16787
16788 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16789 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16790 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16791 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16792 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16793 caused by a denial of service attack.
16794
16795 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16796 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16797 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16798 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16799 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16800 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16801 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16802 denial of service attack.
16803
16804 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16805 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16806 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16807 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16808 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16809 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16810 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16811 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16812 processed than on other servers.
16813
16814 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16815 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16816 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16817 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16818 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16819 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16820 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16821 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16822 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16823 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16824 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16825 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16826 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16827
16828 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16829 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16830 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16831 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16832 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16833 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016834 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016835 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16836
16837 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16838 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16839 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16840 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16841 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16842 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016843 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016844 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16845 occurs.
16846
16847 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16848 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16849 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16850 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16851 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16852 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16853 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16854 cookies" below for more details.
16855
16856 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16857 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16858 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16859 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16860 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16861 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16862 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16863 and cookies" below for more details.
16864
16865 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16866 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16867 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16868 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16869 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16870 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16871 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16872 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16873
16874
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168758.2.4. Custom log format
16876------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016877
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016878The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016879mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016880
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016881HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016882Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16883separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16884prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16885
16886Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16887variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016888("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016889
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016890If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016891as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016892less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16893the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16894
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016895Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016896In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016897in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016898
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016899Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16900'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16901https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16902such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16903
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016904Flags are :
16905 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016906 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016907 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16908 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016909
16910 Example:
16911
16912 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16913 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16914
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016915 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16916
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016917At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16918
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016919 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16920 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016921
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016922the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016923
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016924 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16925 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16926 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016927
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016928and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16929
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016930 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16931 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016932
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016933Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16934
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016935 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016936 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016937 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16938 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16939 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016940 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16941 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16942 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016943 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016944 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16945 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016946 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016947 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16948 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016949 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016950 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016951 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016952 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016953 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016954 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016955 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016956 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16957 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16958 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16959 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16960 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016961 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016962 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16963 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016964 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016965 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16966 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016967 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16968 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16969 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016970 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016971 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16972 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016973 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016974 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16975 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16976 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016977 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016978 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016979 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16980 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16981 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16982 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016983 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016984 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016985 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016986 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016987 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016988 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016989 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16990 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16991 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016992 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016993 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16994 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016995 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016996 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16997 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016998 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016999 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017000 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017001 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017002
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017003 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017004
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017005
170068.2.5. Error log format
17007-----------------------
17008
17009When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17010protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17011By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17012"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017013will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017014logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17015
17016The format looks like this :
17017
17018 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17019 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17020 Connection error during SSL handshake
17021
17022 Field Format Extract from the example above
17023 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17024 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17025 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17026 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17027 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17028
17029These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17030failures.
17031
17032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170338.3. Advanced logging options
17034-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017035
17036Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17037just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17038options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17039for more information about their usage.
17040
17041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170428.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17043------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017044
17045It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17046haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17047commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17048monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17049ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17050
17051 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17052 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17053 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17054 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17055
17056 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17057 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17058 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017059 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017060 such as other load-balancers.
17061
17062 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17063 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17064 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17065
17066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170678.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17068----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017069
17070The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17071what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17072or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017073"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017074just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17075log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17076after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17077is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17078with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17079with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17080
17081
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170828.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17083------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017084
17085Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17086for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17087"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17088retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17089raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17090a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17091file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17092you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17093"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17094
17095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170968.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17097--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017098
17099Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17100multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17101them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17102"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17103logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17104error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17105and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17106too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17107useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17108alternative.
17109
17110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171118.4. Timing events
17112------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017113
17114Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17115reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17116the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17117frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017118mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17119addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17120
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017121Timings events in HTTP mode:
17122
17123 first request 2nd request
17124 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17125 t tr t tr ...
17126 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17127 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17128 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17129 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17130 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17131
17132Timings events in TCP mode:
17133
17134 TCP session
17135 |<----------------->|
17136 t t
17137 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17138 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17139 |<------ Tt ------->|
17140
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017141 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017142 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017143 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17144 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17145 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017146 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017147 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17148 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17149 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17150 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017151
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017152 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17153 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17154 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017155 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17156 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17157 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17158 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17159 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17160 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017161
17162 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17163 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17164 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17165 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17166 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17167 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17168 request typed by hand during a test.
17169
17170 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17171 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017172 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017173 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17174 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17175 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17176 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017177
17178 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17179 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17180 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17181 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17182 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17183
17184 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17185 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17186 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17187 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17188 connection never established.
17189
17190 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17191 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17192 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17193 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17194 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17195 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17196 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17197 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17198 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17199 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17200 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17201
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017202 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17203 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17204 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17205 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17206 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17207 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17208
17209 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17210
17211 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17212 "Ta" can never be negative.
17213
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017214 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17215 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017216 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17217 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017218 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017219
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017220 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017221
17222 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017223 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17224 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017225
17226These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17227protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17228that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017229due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17230"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17231that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017232
17233Most common cases :
17234
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017235 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17236 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17237 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17238 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17239 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17240 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17241 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17242 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17243 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17244 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17245 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017246 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017247
17248 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17249 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17250 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17251 of ms on remote networks.
17252
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017253 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17254 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17255 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017256
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017257 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17258 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17259 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17260 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17261 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17262 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17263 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17264 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17265 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017266
17267Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17268
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017269 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017270 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017271 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017272
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017273 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017274 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17275 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17276
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017277 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017278 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17279 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17280 flags.
17281
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017282 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17283 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017284 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17285 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17286 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17287 the client connection was maintained open.
17288
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017289 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017290 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017291 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017292 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17293
17294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172958.5. Session state at disconnection
17296-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017297
17298TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17299"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
173002-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17301each of which has a special meaning :
17302
17303 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17304 session to terminate :
17305
17306 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17307
17308 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17309 server explicitly refused it.
17310
17311 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17312 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17313 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17314 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017315 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017316
17317 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17318 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017319
17320 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17321 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17322 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17323 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17324 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17325
17326 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17327 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17328 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17329 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17330 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17331
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017332 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17333 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17334
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017335 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17336 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17337 backup connections when going up.
17338
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017339 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17340
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017341 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17342 send or receive data.
17343
17344 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17345 send or receive data.
17346
17347 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17348 with nothing left in the buffers.
17349
17350 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17351
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017352 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017353 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17354
17355 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17356 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17357 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17358 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17359 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17360
17361 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17362 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17363
17364 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17365 server (HTTP only).
17366
17367 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17368
17369 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17370 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17371 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17372
17373 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17374 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17375 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17376
17377 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17378
17379 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17380 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17381
17382 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17383 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17384 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17385
17386 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17387 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017388 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17389 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017390
17391 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17392 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17393 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17394 another server.
17395
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017396 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017397 server.
17398
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017399 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17400 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17401 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17402 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17403
17404 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17405 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17406 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17407 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17408
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017409 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17410 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17411 "use-server" rule).
17412
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017413 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17414
17415 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17416 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17417
17418 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17419
17420 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17421 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17422 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17423
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017424 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17425 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017426 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017427 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17428 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17429
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017430 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17431
17432 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17433 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17434
17435 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17436
17437 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17438
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017439The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17440was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017441helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17442starvation, attacks, etc...
17443
17444The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17445alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17446easier finding and understanding.
17447
17448 Flags Reason
17449
17450 -- Normal termination.
17451
17452 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17453 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17454 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17455 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17456
17457 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17458 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17459 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17460 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17461 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17462 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017463
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017464 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17465 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017466 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017467
17468 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17469 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17470 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17471
17472 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17473 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17474 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17475 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17476 the server takes too long to respond.
17477
17478 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17479 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17480 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17481 long a time to respond.
17482
17483 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17484 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17485 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17486 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017487 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17488 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017489
17490 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17491 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17492 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17493 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17494 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017495 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017496 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17497 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17498 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17499 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17500 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17501 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17502 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17503 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017504 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017505 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17506 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17507 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017508
17509 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17510 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017511 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17512 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17513 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17514 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017515
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017516 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17517 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017519 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017520 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17521 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017522 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017523 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17524 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17525
17526 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17527 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17528 503 or 504 here.
17529
17530 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17531 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17532 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17533 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17534 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17535
17536 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17537 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017538 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017539 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17540 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17541
17542 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17543 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17544 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17545 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17546 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17547 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17548 between haproxy and the server.
17549
17550 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17551 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17552 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17553 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17554 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17555 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17556 solution is to fix the application.
17557
17558 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17559 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17560 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17561 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17562 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17563 external attacks.
17564
17565 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17566 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017567 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017568 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17569 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17570
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017571 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17572 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17573 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017574 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017575 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017576
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017577 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17578 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17579 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17580 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017581 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17582 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17583 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17584 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17585 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017586
17587 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17588 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17589 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17590 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17591
17592 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17593 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17594 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17595 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17596
17597 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17598 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17599 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17600 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17601
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017602The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17603persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17604important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17605re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17606
17607 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17608
17609 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17610 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17611 set on a GET request.
17612
17613 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17614 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017615 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017616 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17617
17618 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17619 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17620 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17621
17622 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17623 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17624 already got a cookie.
17625
17626 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17627 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17628 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17629 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17630 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17631
17632 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17633 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17634 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17635
17636 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17637 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17638 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17639
17640 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17641 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17642
17643 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17644 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17645 then advertised in the response.
17646
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176488.6. Non-printable characters
17649-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017650
17651In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17652consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17653converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17654prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17655being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17656escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17657is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17658'}' when logging headers.
17659
17660Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17661issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17662containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17663
17664Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17665the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17666performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17667
17668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176698.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17670---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017671
17672Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17673achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017674section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017675cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17676the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17677the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017678locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017679not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17680user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17681a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17682wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17683
17684 Examples :
17685 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17686 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17687
17688 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17689 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17690
17691
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176928.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17693---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017694
17695Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17696proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17697the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17698server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17699
17700Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17701response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017702section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017703
17704It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017705time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17706appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017707are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17708and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17709follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17710request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17711in the logs.
17712
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017713As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17714frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17715an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17716
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017717 Example :
17718 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17719 listen proxy-out
17720 mode http
17721 option httplog
17722 option logasap
17723 log global
17724 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17725
17726 # log the name of the virtual server
17727 capture request header Host len 20
17728
17729 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17730 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17731
17732 # log the beginning of the referrer
17733 capture request header Referer len 20
17734
17735 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17736 capture response header Server len 20
17737
17738 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17739 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17740
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017741 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017742 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17743
17744 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17745 capture response header Via len 20
17746
17747 # log the URL location during a redirection
17748 capture response header Location len 20
17749
17750 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17751 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17752 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17753 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17754 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17755
17756 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17757 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17758 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17759 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017760 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017761
17762 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17763 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17764 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17765 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17766 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017767 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017768
17769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177708.9. Examples of logs
17771---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017772
17773These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17774them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17775reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17776
17777 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17778 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17779 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17780
17781 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17782 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17783
17784 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17785 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17786 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17787
17788 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17789 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17790
17791 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17792 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17793 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17794
17795 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017796 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017797 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17798 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17799
17800 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17801 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17802 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17803
17804 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17805 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017806 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017807 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17808 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17809 to return the 502 and not the server.
17810
17811 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017812 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017813
17814 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17815 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17816 Nothing was sent to any server.
17817
17818 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17819 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17820
17821 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17822 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017823 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017824 send a 408 return code to the client.
17825
17826 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17827 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17828
17829 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17830 5 seconds ("c----").
17831
17832 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17833 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017834 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017835
17836 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017837 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017838 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17839 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17840 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17841 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17842 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017843
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017844
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178459. Supported filters
17846--------------------
17847
17848Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17849accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17850unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17851
17852See also : "filter"
17853
178549.1. Trace
17855----------
17856
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017857filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017858
17859 Arguments:
17860 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17861 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17862
17863 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17864 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17865 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17866 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17867
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017868 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017869 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17870 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17871 amount of the parsed data.
17872
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017873 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017874
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017875This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17876callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17877information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17878filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17879
17880Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17881tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17882a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17883
17884
178859.2. HTTP compression
17886---------------------
17887
17888filter compression
17889
17890The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17891keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017892when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17893it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17894response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17895line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17896cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17897the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017898
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017899See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017900
17901
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200179029.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17903--------------------------------------------
17904
17905filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17906
17907 Arguments :
17908
17909 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17910 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17911 parsed.
17912
17913 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17914 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17915 part must be placed in its own scope.
17916
17917The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17918external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017919streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017920exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17921also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17922
17923SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17924the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17925
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017926For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017927"doc/SPOE.txt".
17928
17929Important note:
17930 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17931 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17932
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179339.4. Cache
17934----------
17935
17936filter cache <name>
17937
17938 Arguments :
17939
17940 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17941
17942The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17943"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17944cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017945other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17946the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17947mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17948filter other than the compression is used for the same
17949listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17950order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017951
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017952See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017953
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001795410. Cache
17955---------
17956
17957HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17958(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17959RAM.
17960
17961The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017962this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017963
17964If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17965independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17966when we try to allocate a new one.
17967
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017968The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017969
17970It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17971"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17972for more details.
17973
17974When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17975replaced by "<CACHE>".
17976
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001797710.1. Limitation
17978----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017979
17980The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17981
17982- If the response is not a 200
17983- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017984- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017985- If the response is not cacheable
17986
17987- If the request is not a GET
17988- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017989- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017990
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017991Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
17992filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
17993can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
17994example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
17995"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017996
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001799710.2. Setup
17998-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017999
18000To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18001the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18002
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001800310.2.1. Cache section
18004---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018005
18006cache <name>
18007 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18008 size of cache is mandatory.
18009
18010total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018011 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018012 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018013
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018014max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018015 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18016 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18017 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018018
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018019max-age <seconds>
18020 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18021 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18022 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18023 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18024 default.
18025
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001802610.2.2. Proxy section
18027---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018028
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018029http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018030 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18031 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18032 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18033 after this one.
18034
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018035http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018036 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18037 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18038 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18039 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18040
18041
18042Example:
18043
18044 backend bck1
18045 mode http
18046
18047 http-request cache-use foobar
18048 http-response cache-store foobar
18049 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18050
18051 cache foobar
18052 total-max-size 4
18053 max-age 240
18054
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018055/*
18056 * Local variables:
18057 * fill-column: 79
18058 * End:
18059 */